blob: 96766438f5587a7221c59da7161fa16d3b4a2548 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau15480d72014-06-19 21:10:58 +02005 version 1.6
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau8747b6d2015-03-11 23:57:23 +01007 2015/03/11
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020053
544. Proxies
554.1. Proxy keywords matrix
564.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
57
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200585. Bind and Server options
595.1. Bind options
605.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020061
626. HTTP header manipulation
63
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200647. Using ACLs and fetching samples
657.1. ACL basics
667.1.1. Matching booleans
677.1.2. Matching integers
687.1.3. Matching strings
697.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
707.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
717.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
727.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
737.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200747.3.1. Converters
757.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
767.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
777.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
787.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
797.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200807.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020081
828. Logging
838.1. Log levels
848.2. Log formats
858.2.1. Default log format
868.2.2. TCP log format
878.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100888.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100898.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200908.3. Advanced logging options
918.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
928.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
938.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
948.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
958.4. Timing events
968.5. Session state at disconnection
978.6. Non-printable characters
988.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
998.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1008.9. Examples of logs
101
1029. Statistics and monitoring
1039.1. CSV format
1049.2. Unix Socket commands
105
106
1071. Quick reminder about HTTP
108----------------------------
109
110When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
111fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
112on almost anything found in the contents.
113
114However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
115formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
116correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
117
118
1191.1. The HTTP transaction model
120-------------------------------
121
122The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100123to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
125connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
126will involve a new connection :
127
128 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
129
130In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
131establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
132by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
133length.
134
135Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
136to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
137however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
138response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
139header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
140
141 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
142
143Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
144power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
145but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200146a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200147
148A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
149keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
150second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
151page :
152
153 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
154
155This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
156latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
157correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
158the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100159server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100161By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
162connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
163leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
164start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200165
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100166HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
167 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
168 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
169 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
170 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
171 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
172 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
173
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174
1751.2. HTTP request
176-----------------
177
178First, let's consider this HTTP request :
179
180 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100181 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
183 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
184 3 User-agent: my small browser
185 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
186 5 Accept: image/png
187
188
1891.2.1. The Request line
190-----------------------
191
192Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
193
194 - a METHOD : GET
195 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
196 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
197
198All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
199which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
200followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
201is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
202desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
203the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
204
205The URI itself can have several forms :
206
207 - A "relative URI" :
208
209 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
210
211 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
212 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
213
214 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
215
216 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
217
218 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
219 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
220 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
221 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
222 must accept this form too.
223
224 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
225 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
226 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100227
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200228 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
229 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
230 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
231 other protocols too.
232
233In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
234mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
235on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
236It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
237specific to the language, framework or application in use.
238
239
2401.2.2. The request headers
241--------------------------
242
243The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
244beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
245an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
246Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
247values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
248encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
249the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
250define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
251
252Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
253their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
254"Connection:" header).
255
256The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
257that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
258is one valid form of empty line.
259
260Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
261headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
262about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
263application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
264
265Important note:
266 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
267 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
268 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
269 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
270
271
2721.3. HTTP response
273------------------
274
275An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
276messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
277
278 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100279 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200280 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
281 2 Content-length: 350
282 3 Content-Type: text/html
283
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200284As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
285codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
286response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100287continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
288the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
289following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
290sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
291(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
292correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
293such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
294state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
295over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
296if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
297information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200298
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299
3001.3.1. The Response line
301------------------------
302
303Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
304
305 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
306 - a status code : 200
307 - a reason : OK
308
309The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200310 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200311 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
312 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
313 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
314 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
315
316Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100317"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200318found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
319messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
320or "Authentication Required".
321
322Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
323
324 Code When / reason
325 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
326 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
327 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
328 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100329 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
330 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200331 400 for an invalid or too large request
332 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
333 accessing the stats page)
334 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
335 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
336 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
337 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
338 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
339 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
340 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
341 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
342 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
343
344The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3454.2).
346
347
3481.3.2. The response headers
349---------------------------
350
351Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
352the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
353details.
354
355
3562. Configuring HAProxy
357----------------------
358
3592.1. Configuration file format
360------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200361
362HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
363
364 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
365 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
366 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
367 "frontend" and "backend".
368
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100369The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
370referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200371delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200373
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02003742.2. Quoting and escaping
375-------------------------
376
377HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
378many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
379with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
380single quotes.
381
382If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
383them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
384escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
385
386Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
387
388 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
389 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
390 \\ to use a backslash
391 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
392 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
393
394Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
395the interpretation of:
396
397 space as a parameter separator
398 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
399 # hash as a comment start
400
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200401Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
402-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
403backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
404
405Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200406quoting.
407
408Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
409nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
410
411Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
412equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
413
414 Example:
415 # those are equivalents:
416 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
417 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
418 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
419 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
420 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
421
422 # those are equivalents:
423 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
424 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
425 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
426 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
427
428
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004292.3. Environment variables
430--------------------------
431
432HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
433interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
434configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
435optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
436shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
437underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
438
439 Example:
440
441 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
442
443 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
444
445 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
446
447
4482.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200449----------------
450
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100451Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100452values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
453otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
454numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
455for every keyword. Supported units are :
456
457 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
458 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
459 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
460 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
461 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
462 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
463
464
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004652.4. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200466-------------
467
468 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
469 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
470 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
471 global
472 daemon
473 maxconn 256
474
475 defaults
476 mode http
477 timeout connect 5000ms
478 timeout client 50000ms
479 timeout server 50000ms
480
481 frontend http-in
482 bind *:80
483 default_backend servers
484
485 backend servers
486 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
487
488
489 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
490 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
491 global
492 daemon
493 maxconn 256
494
495 defaults
496 mode http
497 timeout connect 5000ms
498 timeout client 50000ms
499 timeout server 50000ms
500
501 listen http-in
502 bind *:80
503 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
504
505
506Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
507
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100508 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200509
510
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005113. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200512--------------------
513
514Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
515are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
516of them have command-line equivalents.
517
518The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
519
520 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200521 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200522 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200523 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200524 - daemon
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900525 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200526 - gid
527 - group
528 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100529 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200530 - nbproc
531 - pidfile
532 - uid
533 - ulimit-n
534 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200535 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100536 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200537 - node
538 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100539 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100540
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200541 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200542 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200543 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200544 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100545 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100546 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100547 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200548 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200549 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200550 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200551 - noepoll
552 - nokqueue
553 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100554 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300555 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200556 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200557 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200558 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100559 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100560 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200561 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100562 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100563 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100564 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100565 - tune.lua.session-timeout
566 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100567 - tune.maxaccept
568 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200569 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200570 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200571 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100572 - tune.rcvbuf.client
573 - tune.rcvbuf.server
574 - tune.sndbuf.client
575 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100576 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100577 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200578 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100579 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200580 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100581 - tune.zlib.memlevel
582 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100583
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200584 * Debugging
585 - debug
586 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200587
588
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005893.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200590------------------------------------
591
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200592ca-base <dir>
593 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200594 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
595 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200596
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200597chroot <jail dir>
598 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
599 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
600 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
601 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
602 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
603 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100604
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100605cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
606 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
607 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
608 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100609 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
610 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
611 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
612 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
613 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
614 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
615 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
616 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
617 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
618 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100619
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200620crt-base <dir>
621 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
622 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
623 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
624
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200625daemon
626 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
627 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
628 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
629
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900630external-check
631 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
632 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
633 See "option external-check".
634
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200635gid <number>
636 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
637 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
638 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100639 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
640 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200641 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100642
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200643group <group name>
644 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
645 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100646
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200647log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200648 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
649 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100650 configured with "log global".
651
652 <address> can be one of:
653
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100654 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100655 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
656 port).
657
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100658 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
659 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
660 port).
661
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100662 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
663 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
664 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
665 writeable).
666
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200667 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
668 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100669
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200670 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
671 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
672 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
673 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
674 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
675 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
676 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
677 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
678 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
679 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
680 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
681
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100682 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200683
684 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
685 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
686 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
687
688 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200689 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
690 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
691 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
692 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
693 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
694 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200695
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200696 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200697
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100698log-send-hostname [<string>]
699 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
700 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
701 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
702 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
703 the logs.
704
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000705log-tag <string>
706 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
707 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
708 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100709 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000710
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100711lua-load <file>
712 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
713 used multiple times.
714
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200715nbproc <number>
716 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
717 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
718 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
719 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
720 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
721
722pidfile <pidfile>
723 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
724 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
725 starting the process. See also "daemon".
726
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100727stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200728 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
729 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
730 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
731 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
732 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
733 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100734 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200735 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
736 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200737
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100738ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
739 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
740 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300741 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100742 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
743 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
744 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
745 "bind" keyword for more information.
746
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100747ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
748 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
749 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
750 keyword to see available options.
751
752 Example:
753 global
754 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
755
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100756ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
757 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
758 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300759 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100760 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
761 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
762 information.
763
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100764ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
765 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
766 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
767 keyword to see available options.
768
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100769ssl-server-verify [none|required]
770 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
771 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
772 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
773
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200774stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
775 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
776 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
777 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
778 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200779
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200780 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
781 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
782 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200783
784stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
785 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
786 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100787 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200788
789stats maxconn <connections>
790 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
791 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
792
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200793uid <number>
794 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
795 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
796 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
797 one. See also "gid" and "user".
798
799ulimit-n <number>
800 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
801 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
802 option.
803
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100804unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
805 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
806
807 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
808 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
809 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
810 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
811 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
812 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
813 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
814 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
815 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
816 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
817
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200818user <user name>
819 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
820 See also "uid" and "group".
821
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200822node <name>
823 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
824
825 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
826 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
827 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
828 traffic.
829
830description <text>
831 Add a text that describes the instance.
832
833 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
834 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
835 "<" and ">" characters.
836
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200837
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008383.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200839-----------------------
840
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200841max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
842 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
843 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
844 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
845 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
846 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
847 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
848 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
849 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
850
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200851maxconn <number>
852 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
853 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
854 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +0200855 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
856 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
857 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
858 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +0100859 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
860 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
861 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
862 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
863 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200864
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200865maxconnrate <number>
866 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
867 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
868 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
869 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
870 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
871 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
872 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
873 fairness.
874
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100875maxcomprate <number>
876 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300877 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100878 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
879 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
880 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
881 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
882 default value.
883
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100884maxcompcpuusage <number>
885 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
886 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
887 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
888 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
889 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
890 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
891 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
892 process down and from introducing high latencies.
893
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100894maxpipes <number>
895 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
896 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
897 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
898 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
899 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
900 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
901
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200902maxsessrate <number>
903 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
904 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
905 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
906 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
907 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
908 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
909 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
910 fairness.
911
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200912maxsslconn <number>
913 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
914 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
915 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
916 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
917 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
918 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
919 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +0100920 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
921 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
922 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
923 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
924 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
925 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
926 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200927
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200928maxsslrate <number>
929 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
930 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
931 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
932 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
933 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
934 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
935 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
936 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
937 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
938 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
939
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100940maxzlibmem <number>
941 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
942 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
943 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100944 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
945 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
946 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
947
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200948noepoll
949 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
950 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100951 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200952
953nokqueue
954 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
955 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
956 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
957
958nopoll
959 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
960 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100961 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100962 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200963
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100964nosplice
965 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
966 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
967 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100968 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100969 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
970 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
971 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
972 "option splice-response".
973
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300974nogetaddrinfo
975 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
976 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
977
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200978spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900979 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
980 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
981 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
982 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
983 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
984 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200985
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +0100986tune.buffers.limit <number>
987 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
988 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
989 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
990 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
991 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
992 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
993 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
994 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
995 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
996 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
997 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
998 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
999 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1000 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1001 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1002
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001003tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1004 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1005 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1006 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1007 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1008
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001009tune.bufsize <number>
1010 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1011 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1012 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1013 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1014 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1015 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1016 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
1017 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001018 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
1019 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1020 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001021
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001022tune.chksize <number>
1023 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1024 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1025 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1026 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1027 checks whenever possible.
1028
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001029tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1030 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1031 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1032 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1033 this value. The default value is 1.
1034
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001035tune.http.cookielen <number>
1036 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1037 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1038 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1039 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1040 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1041 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1042 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1043 to change this value.
1044
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001045tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1046 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1047 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1048 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1049 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1050 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1051 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
1052 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
1053 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
1054 limit too high.
1055
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001056tune.idletimer <timeout>
1057 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1058 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1059 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1060 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1061 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1062 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
1063 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
1064 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1065 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1066
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001067tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1068 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
1069 instructions executed. This permits interruptng a long script and allows the
1070 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1071 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
1072 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1073 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1074 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1075
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001076tune.lua.maxmem
1077 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1078 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1079 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1080 memory.
1081
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001082tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1083 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
1084 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout has a
1085 priority over other timeouts. For example, if this timeout is set to 4s and
1086 you run a 5s sleep, the code will be interrupted with an error after waiting
1087 4s.
1088
1089tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1090 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1091 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1092 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1093 check servers.
1094
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001095tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001096 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1097 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1098 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1099 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1100 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1101 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1102 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1103 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1104 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1105 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001106
1107tune.maxpollevents <number>
1108 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1109 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1110 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1111 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1112 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1113
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001114tune.maxrewrite <number>
1115 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1116 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1117 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1118 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1119 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1120 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1121 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1122 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1123 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1124 bufsize.
1125
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001126tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1127 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1128 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1129 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1130 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1131 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1132 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1133 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1134 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1135 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1136 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1137 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1138 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1139 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1140 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1141 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1142 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1143 setting this parameter to 0.
1144
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001145tune.pipesize <number>
1146 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1147 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1148 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1149 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1150 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1151 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1152
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001153tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1154tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1155 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1156 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1157 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1158 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1159 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1160 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1161 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1162
1163tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1164tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1165 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1166 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1167 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1168 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1169 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1170 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1171 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1172 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1173 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1174 notifying haproxy again.
1175
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001176tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001177 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1178 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1179 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001180 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001181 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1182 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1183 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1184 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1185 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001186 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1187 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001188
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001189tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1190 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1191 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1192 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1193 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1194 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1195 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1196
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001197tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1198 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001199 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001200 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1201 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1202 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1203 being used for too long.
1204
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001205tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1206 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1207 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1208 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1209 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1210 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1211 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1212 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1213 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1214 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1215 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001216 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1217 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001218
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001219tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1220 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1221 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1222 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1223 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1224 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1225 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1226 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
1227 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied via the certificate file.
1228
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001229tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1230 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001231 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001232 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1233 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1234 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1235
1236tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1237 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1238 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1239 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1240 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001241
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012423.3. Debugging
1243--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001244
1245debug
1246 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1247 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1248 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1249 system startup.
1250
1251quiet
1252 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1253 line argument "-q".
1254
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001255
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010012563.4. Userlists
1257--------------
1258It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1259http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1260it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1261
1262userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001263 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001264 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1265
1266group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001267 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001268 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1269 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1270
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001271user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1272 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001273 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1274 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001275 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1276 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001277 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001278 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001279
1280
1281 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001282 userlist L1
1283 group G1 users tiger,scott
1284 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001285
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001286 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1287 user scott insecure-password elgato
1288 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001289
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001290 userlist L2
1291 group G1
1292 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001293
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001294 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1295 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1296 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001297
1298 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001299
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001300
13013.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001302----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001303It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1304haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1305pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1306identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1307or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1308Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1309known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1310the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1311process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1312during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1313tables.
1314
1315peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001316 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001317 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1318
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001319disabled
1320 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1321 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1322 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1323
1324enable
1325 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1326
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001327peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1328 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1329 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1330 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1331 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1332 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1333 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1334
1335 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1336 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1337
1338 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1339 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1340 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1341 across all peers.
1342
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001343 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1344 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001345
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001346 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001347 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001348 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1349 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1350 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001351
1352 backend mybackend
1353 mode tcp
1354 balance roundrobin
1355 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1356 stick on src
1357
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001358 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1359 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001360
1361
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090013623.6. Mailers
1363------------
1364It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1365If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1366in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1367
1368mailer <mailersect>
1369 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1370 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1371
1372mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1373 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1374
1375 Example:
1376 mailers mymailers
1377 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1378 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1379
1380 backend mybackend
1381 mode tcp
1382 balance roundrobin
1383
1384 email-alert mailers mymailers
1385 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1386 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1387
1388 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1389 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1390
1391
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013924. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001393----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001394
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001395Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001396 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001397 - frontend <name>
1398 - backend <name>
1399 - listen <name>
1400
1401A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1402its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1403section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001404section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001405
1406A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1407connections.
1408
1409A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1410to forward incoming connections.
1411
1412A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1413parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1414
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001415All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1416'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1417case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1418
1419Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1420logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1421proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1422However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1423name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1424
1425Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1426and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001427bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001428protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1429modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1430arbitrary criteria.
1431
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001432In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1433a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1434the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1435
1436 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1437 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1438 between responses and new requests.
1439
1440 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1441 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1442 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1443 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1444
1445 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1446 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1447 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1448
1449 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1450 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1451 client-facing connection remains open.
1452
1453 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1454 after the end of the response.
1455
1456The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1457frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1458following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1459weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1460
1461 Backend mode
1462
1463 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1464 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1465 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1466 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1467 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1468 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1469 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1470 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1471 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1472 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1473 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1474
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001475
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001476
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014774.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1478--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001479
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001480The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1481limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1482they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1483limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001484marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001485option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001486and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1487with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1488specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001489
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001490
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001491 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1492------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1493acl - X X X
1494appsession - - X X
1495backlog X X X -
1496balance X - X X
1497bind - X X -
1498bind-process X X X X
1499block - X X X
1500capture cookie - X X -
1501capture request header - X X -
1502capture response header - X X -
1503clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001504compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001505contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1506cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02001507declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001508default-server X - X X
1509default_backend X X X -
1510description - X X X
1511disabled X X X X
1512dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001513email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001514email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001515email-alert mailers X X X X
1516email-alert myhostname X X X X
1517email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001518enabled X X X X
1519errorfile X X X X
1520errorloc X X X X
1521errorloc302 X X X X
1522-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1523errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001524force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001525fullconn X - X X
1526grace X X X X
1527hash-type X - X X
1528http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001529http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001530http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001531http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001532http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001533http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001534id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001535ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001536log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001537log-format X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001538log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001539max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001540maxconn X X X -
1541mode X X X X
1542monitor fail - X X -
1543monitor-net X X X -
1544monitor-uri X X X -
1545option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1546option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1547option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1548option allbackups (*) X - X X
1549option checkcache (*) X - X X
1550option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1551option contstats (*) X X X -
1552option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1553option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1554option forceclose (*) X X X X
1555-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1556option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02001557option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02001558option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001559option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001560option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001561option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001562option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001563option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001564option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1565option httpchk X - X X
1566option httpclose (*) X X X X
1567option httplog X X X X
1568option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001569option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001570option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001571option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001572option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1573option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1574option logasap (*) X X X -
1575option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001576option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001577option nolinger (*) X X X X
1578option originalto X X X X
1579option persist (*) X - X X
1580option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001581option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001582option smtpchk X - X X
1583option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1584option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1585option splice-request (*) X X X X
1586option splice-response (*) X X X X
1587option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1588option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1589-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001590option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001591option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1592option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1593option tcpka X X X X
1594option tcplog X X X X
1595option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001596external-check command X - X X
1597external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001598persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1599rate-limit sessions X X X -
1600redirect - X X X
1601redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1602redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1603reqadd - X X X
1604reqallow - X X X
1605reqdel - X X X
1606reqdeny - X X X
1607reqiallow - X X X
1608reqidel - X X X
1609reqideny - X X X
1610reqipass - X X X
1611reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001612reqitarpit - X X X
1613reqpass - X X X
1614reqrep - X X X
1615-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001616reqtarpit - X X X
1617retries X - X X
1618rspadd - X X X
1619rspdel - X X X
1620rspdeny - X X X
1621rspidel - X X X
1622rspideny - X X X
1623rspirep - X X X
1624rsprep - X X X
1625server - - X X
1626source X - X X
1627srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001628stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001629stats auth X - X X
1630stats enable X - X X
1631stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001632stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001633stats realm X - X X
1634stats refresh X - X X
1635stats scope X - X X
1636stats show-desc X - X X
1637stats show-legends X - X X
1638stats show-node X - X X
1639stats uri X - X X
1640-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1641stick match - - X X
1642stick on - - X X
1643stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001644stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001645stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001646tcp-check connect - - X X
1647tcp-check expect - - X X
1648tcp-check send - - X X
1649tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001650tcp-request connection - X X -
1651tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001652tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001653tcp-response content - - X X
1654tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001655timeout check X - X X
1656timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001657timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001658timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1659timeout connect X - X X
1660timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1661timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1662timeout http-request X X X X
1663timeout queue X - X X
1664timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001665timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001666timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1667timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001668timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001669transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001670unique-id-format X X X -
1671unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001672use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001673use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001674------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1675 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001676
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001677
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016784.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1679---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001680
1681This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1682
1683
1684acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1685 Declare or complete an access list.
1686 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1687 no | yes | yes | yes
1688 Example:
1689 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1690 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1691 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1692
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001693 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001694
1695
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001696appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1697 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001698 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1699 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1700 no | no | yes | yes
1701 Arguments :
1702 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1703 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1704
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001705 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001706 checked in each cookie value.
1707
1708 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1709 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1710 milliseconds.
1711
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001712 request-learn
1713 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1714 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1715 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1716 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1717 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1718 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1719
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001720 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1721 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1722 data following this prefix.
1723
1724 Example :
1725 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1726
1727 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1728 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1729
1730 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1731 2 modes are currently supported :
1732 - path-parameters :
1733 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1734 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1735 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1736 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1737 - query-string :
1738 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1739 query string.
1740
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001741 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1742 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1743 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1744 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001745 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1746 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1747 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001748 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1749 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1750
1751 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1752
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001753 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1754 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1755 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1756
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001757 Example :
1758 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1759
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001760 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1761 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001762
1763
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001764backlog <conns>
1765 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1766 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1767 yes | yes | yes | no
1768 Arguments :
1769 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1770 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001771 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001772
1773 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1774 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1775 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1776 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1777 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1778 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1779 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1780 backlog parameter.
1781
1782 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1783 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1784 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1785
1786 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1787
1788
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001789balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001790balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001791 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1792 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1793 yes | no | yes | yes
1794 Arguments :
1795 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1796 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1797 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1798 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1799
1800 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1801 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1802 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1803 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001804 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001805 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001806 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1807 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1808 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1809 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1810 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1811 it, so that you don't worry.
1812
1813 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1814 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1815 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1816 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1817 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1818 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1819 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1820 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001821
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001822 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1823 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1824 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1825 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1826 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1827 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1828 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1829 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1830
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001831 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001832 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001833 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1834 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001835 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001836 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1837 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1838 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1839 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1840 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001841 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1842 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1843 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1844 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1845 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1846 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001847
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001848 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1849 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1850 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1851 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1852 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1853 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1854 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1855 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001856 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001857 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001858 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1859 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1860 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001861
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001862 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1863 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1864 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1865 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1866 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1867 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1868 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1869 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1870 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1871 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1872 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1873 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001874
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001875 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001876 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1877 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1878 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1879 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1880 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1881 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1882 URIs start with a leading "/".
1883
1884 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1885 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1886 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1887 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1888
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001889 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001890 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1891
1892 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001893 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1894 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001895 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
1896 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
1897 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
1898 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001899 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001900 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
1901 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001902
1903 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1904 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1905 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1906 server will receive the request.
1907
1908 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1909 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1910 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1911 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1912 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001913 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1914 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1915 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001916
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001917 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1918 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1919 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1920 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1921 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001922
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001923 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001924 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1925 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1926 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1927
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001928 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1929 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1930 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1931
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001932 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001933 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001934 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1935 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1936 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1937 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1938 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1939 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001940 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001941 used instead.
1942
1943 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1944 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1945 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1946 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1947
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001948 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1949 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1950 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1951
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001952 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001953
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001954 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001955 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1956 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001957
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001958 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1959 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1960 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001961
1962 Examples :
1963 balance roundrobin
1964 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001965 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001966 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1967 balance hdr(host)
1968 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001969
1970 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1971 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1972
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001973 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001974 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1975 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1976 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1977 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1978
1979 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1980 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1981 defaults to 16 kB.
1982
1983 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1984 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1985
1986 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1987 Round Robin.
1988
1989 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1990 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1991 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1992 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1993
1994 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1995
1996 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001997 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001998 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1999 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2000 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002001
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002002 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
2003 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002004
2005
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002006bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2007bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002008 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2009 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2010 no | yes | yes | no
2011 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002012 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2013 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2014 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2015 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002016 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002017 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2018 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2019 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2020 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2021 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2022 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2023 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002024 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2025 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2026 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2027 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2028 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2029 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2030 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002031 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2032 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2033 be listening.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002034 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2035 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2036 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002037
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002038 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2039 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002040 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2041 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2042 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002043 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2044 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2045 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2046 the range.
2047
2048 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2049 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2050 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2051 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2052 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2053 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2054 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002055 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002056 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002057
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002058 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
2059 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
2060 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2061 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2062 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2063 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2064 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2065 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2066
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002067 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2068 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2069 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2070 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002071
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002072 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2073 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2074 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2075 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2076 in a frontend.
2077
2078 Example :
2079 listen http_proxy
2080 bind :80,:443
2081 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002082 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002083
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002084 listen http_https_proxy
2085 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002086 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002087
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002088 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2089 bind ipv6@:80
2090 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2091 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2092
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002093 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002094 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002095
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002096 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002097 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002098
2099
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002100bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002101 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2102 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2103 yes | yes | yes | yes
2104 Arguments :
2105 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2106 may be used to override a default value.
2107
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002108 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002109 option may be combined with other numbers.
2110
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002111 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002112 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2113 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2114 missing from all processes.
2115
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002116 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002117 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002118 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
2119 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
2120 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
2121 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002122
2123 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2124 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2125 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2126 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2127 and 'even' instances.
2128
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002129 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2130 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2131 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2132 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002133
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002134 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2135 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2136
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002137 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2138 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2139 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2140
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002141 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2142 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2143
2144 Example :
2145 listen app_ip1
2146 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002147 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002148
2149 listen app_ip2
2150 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002151 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002152
2153 listen management
2154 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002155 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002156
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002157 listen management
2158 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2159 bind-process 1-4
2160
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002161 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002162
2163
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002164block { if | unless } <condition>
2165 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2166 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2167 no | yes | yes | yes
2168
2169 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2170 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002171 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002172 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002173 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
2174 "block" statements per instance.
2175
2176 Example:
2177 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2178 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2179 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2180 block if invalid_src || local_dst
2181
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002182 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002183
2184
2185capture cookie <name> len <length>
2186 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2187 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2188 no | yes | yes | no
2189 Arguments :
2190 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2191 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2192 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2193 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2194 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2195
2196 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2197 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2198 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2199 right if it exceeds <length>.
2200
2201 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2202 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2203 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2204 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2205
2206 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2207 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2208 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2209
2210 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2211 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2212 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002213 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2214 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2215 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002216
2217 Example:
2218 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2219
2220 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002221 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002222
2223
2224capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002225 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002226 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2227 no | yes | yes | no
2228 Arguments :
2229 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002230 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002231 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2232 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2233 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2234
2235 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2236 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2237 it exceeds <length>.
2238
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002239 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002240 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2241 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002242 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2243 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2244 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2245 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002246 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002247 environments to find where the request came from.
2248
2249 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2250 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2251 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2252 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002253
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002254 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2255 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2256 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2257 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2258 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002259
2260 Example:
2261 capture request header Host len 15
2262 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
2263 capture request header Referrer len 15
2264
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002265 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002266 about logging.
2267
2268
2269capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002270 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002271 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2272 no | yes | yes | no
2273 Arguments :
2274 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002275 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002276 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2277 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2278 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2279
2280 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2281 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2282 it exceeds <length>.
2283
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002284 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002285 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2286 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2287 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002288 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2289 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2290 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2291 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002292
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002293 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2294 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2295 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2296 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2297 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002298
2299 Example:
2300 capture response header Content-length len 9
2301 capture response header Location len 15
2302
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002303 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002304 about logging.
2305
2306
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002307clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002308 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2309 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2310 yes | yes | yes | no
2311 Arguments :
2312 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2313 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2314 as explained at the top of this document.
2315
2316 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2317 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2318 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2319 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2320 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2321 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2322 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2323 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002324 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002325 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2326 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2327
2328 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2329 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2330 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2331 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2332 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2333 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2334
2335 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2336 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2337
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002338 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2339 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002340
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002341compression algo <algorithm> ...
2342compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002343compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002344 Enable HTTP compression.
2345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2346 yes | yes | yes | yes
2347 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002348 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2349 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2350 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2351
2352 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002353 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2354 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2355 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002356
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002357 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2358 support for zlib was built in.
2359
2360 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2361 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2362 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2363 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2364 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
2365 for zlib was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002366
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002367 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2368 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2369 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2370 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2371 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2372 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2373 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
2374 available when support for zlib was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002375
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002376 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002377 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002378 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2379 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2380 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2381 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2382 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002383
2384 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2385 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2386 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2387 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2388 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002389 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2390 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2391 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2392 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2393 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002394 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2395 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002396
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002397 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002398 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2399 "Accept-Encoding" header
2400 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002401 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002402 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2403 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002404 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2405 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2406 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2407 "multipart"
2408 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2409 header
2410 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2411 and later
2412 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2413 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002414
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002415 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2416 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002417
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002418 Examples :
2419 compression algo gzip
2420 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002421
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002422contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002423 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2424 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2425 yes | no | yes | yes
2426 Arguments :
2427 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2428 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2429 as explained at the top of this document.
2430
2431 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002432 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002433 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002434 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2435 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2436 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2437 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2438
2439 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2440 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2441 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2442 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2443 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2444 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2445
2446 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2447 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2448 instead.
2449
2450 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2451 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2452
2453
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002454cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002455 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2456 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002457 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2458 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2459 yes | no | yes | yes
2460 Arguments :
2461 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2462 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2463 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2464 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2465 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2466 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2467 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2468 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2469 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2470
2471 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2472 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2473 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2474 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2475 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2476 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2477 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2478 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2479 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2480 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2481 "insert" and "prefix".
2482
2483 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002484 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002485
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002486 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002487 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2488 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2489 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2490 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2491 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2492 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2493 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2494 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2495 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2496 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002497
2498 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2499 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2500 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2501 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2502 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2503 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2504 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2505 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2506 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2507 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002508 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2509 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2510 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002511
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002512 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2513 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2514 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002515 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2516 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2517 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2518 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002519 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2520 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2521 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002522
2523 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2524 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2525 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2526 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2527 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2528 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2529 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2530 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2531 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2532
2533 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2534 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2535 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2536 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2537 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2538 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2539 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2540 persistence cookie in the cache.
2541 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2542
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002543 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2544 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2545 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2546 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2547 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2548 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2549 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2550 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2551 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2552 they logout.
2553
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002554 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2555 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2556 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2557 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2558
2559 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2560 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2561 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2562 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2563 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2564 this attribute.
2565
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002566 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002567 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002568 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2569 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2570 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2571 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2572 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2573 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002574
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002575 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2576 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2577 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2578 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2579 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2580 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2581 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2582 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2583 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2584 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2585 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2586 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2587 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2588 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2589 the site.
2590
2591 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2592 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2593 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2594 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2595 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2596 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2597 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2598 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2599 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2600 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2601 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2602 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2603 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2604 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2605 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2606 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2607
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002608 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2609 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2610 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2611 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002612
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002613 Examples :
2614 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2615 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2616 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002617 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002618
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002619 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002620 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002621
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002622
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002623declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
2624 Declares a capture slot.
2625 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2626 no | yes | yes | no
2627 Arguments:
2628 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
2629
2630 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
2631 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
2632 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
2633 for use in the response.
2634
2635 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
2636 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
2637
2638
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002639default-server [param*]
2640 Change default options for a server in a backend
2641 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2642 yes | no | yes | yes
2643 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002644 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2645 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2646 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2647 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002648
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002649 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002650 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2651
2652 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002653
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002654
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002655default_backend <backend>
2656 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2657 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2658 yes | yes | yes | no
2659 Arguments :
2660 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2661
2662 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2663 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2664 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2665 will catch all undetermined requests.
2666
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002667 Example :
2668
2669 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2670 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2671 default_backend dynamic
2672
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02002673 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002674
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002675
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002676description <string>
2677 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2679 no | yes | yes | yes
2680 Arguments : string
2681
2682 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2683 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2684 it describes.
2685 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2686
2687
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002688disabled
2689 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2690 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2691 yes | yes | yes | yes
2692 Arguments : none
2693
2694 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2695 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2696 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2697 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2698 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2699 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2700 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2701
2702 See also : "enabled"
2703
2704
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002705dispatch <address>:<port>
2706 Set a default server address
2707 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2708 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002709 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002710
2711 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2712 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2713 during start-up.
2714
2715 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2716 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2717 possible with normal servers.
2718
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002719 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002720 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2721 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2722 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2723 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2724
2725 See also : "server"
2726
2727
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002728enabled
2729 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2730 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2731 yes | yes | yes | yes
2732 Arguments : none
2733
2734 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2735 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2736
2737 See also : "disabled"
2738
2739
2740errorfile <code> <file>
2741 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2742 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2743 yes | yes | yes | yes
2744 Arguments :
2745 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
CJ Ess108b1dd2015-04-07 12:03:37 -04002746 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
2747 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002748
2749 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002750 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002751 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002752 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2753 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002754
2755 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2756 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2757 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2758
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002759 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2760
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002761 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2762 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2763 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2764 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2765
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002766 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2767 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2768 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2769 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2770 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2771 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2772
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002773 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2774 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2775 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002776 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002777 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2778
2779 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2780
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002781 Example :
2782 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02002783 errorfile 408 /dev/null # workaround Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002784 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2785 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2786
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002787
2788errorloc <code> <url>
2789errorloc302 <code> <url>
2790 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2791 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2792 yes | yes | yes | yes
2793 Arguments :
2794 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002795 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002796
2797 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2798 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2799 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2800 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2801 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2802
2803 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2804 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2805 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2806
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002807 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2808
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002809 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2810 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2811 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2812 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2813 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2814 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2815 request.
2816
2817 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2818
2819
2820errorloc303 <code> <url>
2821 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2822 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2823 yes | yes | yes | yes
2824 Arguments :
2825 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2826 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2827
2828 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2829 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2830 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2831 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2832 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2833
2834 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2835 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2836 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2837
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002838 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2839
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002840 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2841 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2842 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2843 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002844 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002845
2846 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2847
2848
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002849email-alert from <emailaddr>
2850 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
2851 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
2852 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2853 yes | yes | yes | yes
2854
2855 Arguments :
2856
2857 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
2858
2859 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
2860 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
2861
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002862 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
2863 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
2864
2865
2866email-alert level <level>
2867 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
2868 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
2869 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2870 yes | yes | yes | yes
2871
2872 Arguments :
2873
2874 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
2875 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2876 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
2877
2878 By default level is alert
2879
2880 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
2881 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
2882 for the proxy.
2883
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09002884 Alerts are sent when :
2885
2886 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
2887 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
2888 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
2889 is notice or lower
2890 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
2891 and a health check status update occurs
2892
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002893 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
2894 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002895 section 3.6 about mailers.
2896
2897
2898email-alert mailers <mailersect>
2899 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
2900 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2901 yes | yes | yes | yes
2902
2903 Arguments :
2904
2905 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
2906
2907 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
2908 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
2909
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002910 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
2911 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002912
2913
2914email-alert myhostname <hostname>
2915 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
2916 mailers.
2917 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2918 yes | yes | yes | yes
2919
2920 Arguments :
2921
2922 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
2923
2924 By default the systems hostname is used.
2925
2926 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
2927 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
2928 for the proxy.
2929
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002930 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
2931 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002932
2933
2934email-alert to <emailaddr>
2935 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
2936 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
2937 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2938 yes | yes | yes | yes
2939
2940 Arguments :
2941
2942 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
2943
2944 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
2945 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
2946
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002947 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002948 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
2949
2950
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002951force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2952 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2953 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2954 no | yes | yes | yes
2955
2956 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2957 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2958 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2959 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2960 marked down for maintenance operations.
2961
2962 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2963 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2964 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2965 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2966 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2967 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2968 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2969 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2970 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2971
2972 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2973 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2974 is used.
2975
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002976 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002977 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002978
2979
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002980fullconn <conns>
2981 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2982 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2983 yes | no | yes | yes
2984 Arguments :
2985 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2986 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2987
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002988 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002989 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002990 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002991 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2992 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2993 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2994 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2995 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002996 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002997
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002998 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2999 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003000 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3001 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3002 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003003
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003004 Example :
3005 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3006 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3007 # connections.
3008 backend dynamic
3009 fullconn 10000
3010 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3011 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3012
3013 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3014
3015
3016grace <time>
3017 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3018 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003019 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003020 Arguments :
3021 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3022 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3023 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3024
3025 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3026 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003027 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003028 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3029
3030 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3031 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3032 simplify it.
3033
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003034
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003035hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003036 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3038 yes | no | yes | yes
3039 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003040 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3041 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003042
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003043 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3044 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3045 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3046 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3047 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3048 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3049 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3050 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3051 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3052 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003053
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003054 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3055 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3056 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3057 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3058 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3059 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3060 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3061 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3062 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3063 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3064 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3065 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3066 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003067 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3068 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003069
3070 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3071
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003072 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003073 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3074 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3075 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003076 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3077 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3078 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003079
3080 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3081 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003082 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3083 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3084 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3085 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3086
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003087 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3088 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3089 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3090 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3091 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3092 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3093 parameter.
3094
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003095 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3096 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3097 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3098 used on strings.
3099
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003100 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3101
3102 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3103 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3104 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3105 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3106 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3107 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3108 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3109 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3110 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3111 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3112 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3113 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003114
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003115 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3116 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3117 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003118
3119 See also : "balance", "server"
3120
3121
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003122http-check disable-on-404
3123 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003125 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003126 Arguments : none
3127
3128 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3129 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3130 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3131 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3132 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3133 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3134 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3135 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003136 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3137 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3138 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3139
3140 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3141
3142
3143http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003144 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003145 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003146 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003147 Arguments :
3148 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3149 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003150 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003151 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3152 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3153 details on the supported keywords.
3154
3155 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3156 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3157 with the usual backslash ('\').
3158
3159 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3160 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3161 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3162 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3163 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3164
3165 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003166 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003167 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3168 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3169 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3170
3171 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003172 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003173 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3174 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3175 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3176 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3177
3178 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003179 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003180 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3181 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3182 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3183 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3184 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3185 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3186 trace).
3187
3188 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003189 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003190 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3191 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3192 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3193 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3194 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3195 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3196
3197 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3198 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3199 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3200 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3201 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3202 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3203 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3204 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3205
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003206 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3207 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3208 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3209
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003210 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3211 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3212
3213 Examples :
3214 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003215 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003216
3217 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003218 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003219
3220 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003221 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003222
3223 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003224 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003225
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003226 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003227
3228
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003229http-check send-state
3230 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3231 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3232 yes | no | yes | yes
3233 Arguments : none
3234
3235 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3236 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3237 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3238 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3239 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3240
3241 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3242 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3243 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3244 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3245 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003246 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3247 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3248 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3249
3250 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3251 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3252 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3253
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003254 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3255 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3256 checked in multiple backends.
3257
3258 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3259 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3260
3261 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3262 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3263 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3264 one fails.
3265
3266 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3267 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3268 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3269
3270 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3271 server's queue.
3272
3273 Example of a header received by the application server :
3274 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3275 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3276
3277 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3278
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003279http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003280 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003281 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003282 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003283 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3284 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003285 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3286 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003287 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3288 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3289 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003290 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003291 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
3292 lua <function name>
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003293 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003294 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003295 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3296
3297 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3298 no | yes | yes | yes
3299
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003300 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3301 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3302 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3303 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3304 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003305
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003306 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3307 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3308 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3309
3310 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3311 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
3312 are evaluated.
3313
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003314 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3315 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3316 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
3317 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
3318 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3319 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3320 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3321 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3322 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003323 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003324 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
3325
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003326 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3327 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3328 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3329 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3330 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3331
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003332 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3333 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3334 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003335 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3336 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003337
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003338 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3339 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3340 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3341 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3342 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3343 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3344 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3345 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3346
3347 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3348 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3349 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003350 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3351 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003352
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003353 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3354 <name>.
3355
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003356 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3357 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3358 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3359 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3360 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3361 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3362 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3363 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3364
3365 Example:
3366
3367 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3368
3369 applied to:
3370
3371 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3372
3373 outputs:
3374
3375 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3376
3377 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3378
3379 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3380 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3381 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3382 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3383 header.
3384
3385 Example:
3386
3387 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3388
3389 applied to:
3390
3391 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3392
3393 outputs:
3394
3395 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3396
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003397 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3398 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3399 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3400 it.
3401
3402 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3403 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3404 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3405 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3406 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3407 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3408
3409 Example :
3410 # prepend the host name before the path
3411 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3412
3413 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3414 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3415 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3416 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3417 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3418 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3419 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3420 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3421
3422 Example :
3423 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3424 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3425
3426 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3427 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3428 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3429 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3430 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3431 "set-query".
3432
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003433 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3434 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3435 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3436 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3437 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3438 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3439 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3440 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3441
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003442 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3443 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3444 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3445 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3446 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3447 another equipment.
3448
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003449 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3450 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3451 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3452 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3453 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3454 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3455 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3456 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3457
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003458 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3459 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3460 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3461 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3462 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3463 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3464 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3465 admin privileges.
3466
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003467 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3468 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3469 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3470 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3471 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3472 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3473 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3474 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3475
3476 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3477 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3478 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3479 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3480 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3481 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3482
3483 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3484 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3485 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3486 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3487 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3488 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3489
3490 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3491 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3492 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3493 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3494 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3495 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3496 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3497 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3498 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3499
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003500 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02003501 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
3502 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
3503 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
3504 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
3505 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
3506 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
3507 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
3508 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
3509 request header" for more information.
3510
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003511 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
3512 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
3513 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
3514 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
3515
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003516 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3517 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3518 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3519 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3520 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
3521 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
3522 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
3523 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
3524 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
3525 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
3526 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
3527 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
3528
3529 These actions take one or two arguments :
3530 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
3531 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
3532 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
3533 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
3534
3535 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
3536 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
3537 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
3538 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
3539
3540 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
3541 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
3542 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
3543 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
3544 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
3545 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
3546 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
3547 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
3548
3549 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
3550 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
3551 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
3552 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
3553 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
3554
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003555 - "lua" is used to run a Lua function if the action is executed. The single
3556 parameter is the name of the function to run. The prototype of the
3557 function is documented in the API documentation.
3558
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003559 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3560
3561 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3562 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
3563 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
3564 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003565
3566 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003567 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3568 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3569 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003570
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003571 http-request allow if nagios
3572 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3573 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3574 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003575
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003576 Example:
3577 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003578 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003579
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003580 Example:
3581 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3582 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
3583 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
3584 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3585 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3586 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3587 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3588 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3589 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3590
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003591 Example:
3592 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3593 acl add path /addacl
3594 acl del path /delacl
3595
3596 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3597
3598 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3599 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3600
3601 Example:
3602 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3603 acl setmap path /setmap
3604 acl delmap path /delmap
3605
3606 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3607
3608 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3609 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3610
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003611 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3612 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003613
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003614http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02003615 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003616 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003617 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
3618 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003619 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3620 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3621 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3622 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003623 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
3624 lua <function name>
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003625 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003626 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003627 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3628
3629 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3630 no | yes | yes | yes
3631
3632 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3633 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3634 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3635 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3636 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3637 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3638
3639 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3640 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3641 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3642 current section.
3643
3644 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3645 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3646 rules are evaluated.
3647
3648 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3649 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3650 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3651 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3652 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3653 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3654 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3655
3656 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3657 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3658 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3659 external users.
3660
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003661 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3662 <name>.
3663
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003664 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3665 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3666 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3667 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3668 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3669 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3670 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3671 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
3672
3673 Example:
3674
3675 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
3676
3677 applied to:
3678
3679 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3680
3681 outputs:
3682
3683 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3684
3685 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
3686
3687 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3688 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3689 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3690 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3691 header.
3692
3693 Example:
3694
3695 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
3696
3697 applied to:
3698
3699 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
3700
3701 outputs:
3702
3703 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
3704
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003705 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3706 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3707 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3708 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3709 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3710 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3711 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3712 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3713
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003714 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3715 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3716 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3717 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3718 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3719 another equipment.
3720
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003721 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3722 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3723 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3724 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3725 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3726 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3727 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3728 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3729
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003730 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3731 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3732 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3733 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3734 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3735 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3736 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3737 admin privileges.
3738
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003739 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3740 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3741 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3742 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3743 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3744 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3745 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3746 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3747
3748 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3749 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3750 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3751 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3752 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3753 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3754
3755 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3756 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3757 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3758 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3759 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3760 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3761
3762 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3763 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3764 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3765 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3766 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3767 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3768 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3769 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3770 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3771
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003772 - "lua" is used to run a Lua function if the action is executed. The single
3773 parameter is the name of the function to run. The prototype of the
3774 function is documented in the API documentation.
3775
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02003776 - capture <sample> id <id> :
3777 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
3778 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
3779 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
3780 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
3781 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
3782 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
3783 response header" for more information.
3784
3785 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
3786 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
3787 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
3788 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
3789 keyword.
3790
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02003791 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3792 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
3793 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
3794 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
3795 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
3796 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
3797
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003798 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3799
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003800 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003801 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3802 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3803 rules.
3804
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003805 Example:
3806 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
3807
3808 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3809
3810 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3811 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3812
3813 Example:
3814 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3815
3816 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3817
3818 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
3819 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
3820
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003821 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3822 ACL usage.
3823
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003824
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003825http-send-name-header [<header>]
3826 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3827
3828 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3829 yes | no | yes | yes
3830
3831 Arguments :
3832
3833 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3834
3835 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3836 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3837 is added with the header string proved.
3838
3839 See also : "server"
3840
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003841id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003842 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3843 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3844 no | yes | yes | yes
3845 Arguments : none
3846
3847 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3848 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3849 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003850
3851
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003852ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3853 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3854 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3855 no | yes | yes | yes
3856
3857 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3858 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3859 and running).
3860
3861 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3862 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3863 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003864 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003865 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3866
3867 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3868 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3869
3870 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3871 "unless" condition is met.
3872
3873 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3874
3875
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003876log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003877log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003878no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003879 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3880 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3881 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003882
3883 Prefix :
3884 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3885 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3886 prefix does not allow arguments.
3887
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003888 Arguments :
3889 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3890 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3891 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3892 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3893 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3894 parameter.
3895
3896 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3897 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3898
3899 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3900 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3901 standard syslog port).
3902
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003903 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3904 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3905 standard syslog port).
3906
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003907 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3908 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3909 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3910 appropriately writeable).
3911
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003912 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3913 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003914
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003915 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
3916 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
3917 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
3918 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
3919 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
3920 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
3921 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
3922 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
3923 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
3924 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
3925 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
3926
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003927 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3928
3929 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3930 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3931 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3932
3933 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3934 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3935 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003936 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3937 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3938 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3939 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3940 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003941
3942 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3943
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003944 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3945 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3946 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003947
3948 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3949 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3950 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3951 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3952
3953 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3954 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003955
3956 Example :
3957 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003958 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3959 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003960 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003961
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003962
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003963log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003964 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
3965 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3966 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003967
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003968 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
3969 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
3970 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
3971 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
3972 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003973
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003974log-tag <string>
3975 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
3976 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3977 yes | yes | yes | yes
3978
3979 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
3980 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
3981 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
3982 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
3983 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
3984 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
3985 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
3986 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
3987 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003988
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003989max-keep-alive-queue <value>
3990 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
3991 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3992 yes | no | yes | yes
3993
3994 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
3995 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
3996 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
3997 servers.
3998
3999 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
4000 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
4001 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
4002 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
4003 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
4004 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
4005 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
4006 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
4007 picking a different server.
4008
4009 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
4010 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
4011 even if they have to be queued.
4012
4013 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
4014 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
4015
4016
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004017maxconn <conns>
4018 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
4019 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4020 yes | yes | yes | no
4021 Arguments :
4022 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
4023 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
4024 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
4025 closes.
4026
4027 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
4028 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
4029 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
4030 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
4031 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
4032 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
4033 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
4034 properly tuned.
4035
4036 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
4037 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
4038 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
4039
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02004040 By default, this value is set to 2000.
4041
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004042 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
4043
4044
4045mode { tcp|http|health }
4046 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
4047 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4048 yes | yes | yes | yes
4049 Arguments :
4050 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
4051 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
4052 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
4053 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
4054
4055 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
4056 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
4057 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
4058 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
4059 brings HAProxy most of its value.
4060
4061 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004062 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
4063 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
4064 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
4065 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
4066 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
4067 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
4068 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004069
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004070 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
4071 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
4072 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004073
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004074 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004075 defaults http_instances
4076 mode http
4077
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004078 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004079
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004080
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004081monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004082 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004083 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4084 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004085 Arguments :
4086 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
4087 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004088 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004089 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
4090 backend and its backup.
4091
4092 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
4093 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
4094 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
4095 servers in a list of backends.
4096
4097 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
4098 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
4099 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
4100 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
4101 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
4102 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
4103 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004104 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
4105 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004106
4107 Example:
4108 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004109 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004110 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
4111 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
4112 monitor-uri /site_alive
4113 monitor fail if site_dead
4114
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004115 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004116
4117
4118monitor-net <source>
4119 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
4120 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4121 yes | yes | yes | no
4122 Arguments :
4123 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
4124 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
4125 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
4126 followed by a mask.
4127
4128 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
4129 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004130 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004131 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
4132
4133 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
4134 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
4135 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
4136 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004137 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
4138 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
4139 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004140
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004141 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
4142 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
4143 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
4144 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
4145 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
4146 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004147
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01004148 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
4149 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004150
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004151 Example :
4152 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
4153 frontend www
4154 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
4155
4156 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
4157
4158
4159monitor-uri <uri>
4160 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
4161 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4162 yes | yes | yes | no
4163 Arguments :
4164 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
4165 health status instead of forwarding the request.
4166
4167 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
4168 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
4169 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
4170 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
4171 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
4172 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
4173 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
4174 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
4175
4176 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
4177 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
4178 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
4179 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
4180 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
4181 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
4182
4183 Example :
4184 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
4185 frontend www
4186 mode http
4187 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
4188
4189 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
4190
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004191
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004192option abortonclose
4193no option abortonclose
4194 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
4195 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4196 yes | no | yes | yes
4197 Arguments : none
4198
4199 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
4200 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
4201 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
4202 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004203 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004204 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
4205 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
4206 encountered while delivering the response.
4207
4208 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
4209 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
4210 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
4211 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
4212 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
4213 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004214 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004215 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004216 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004217 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
4218 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
4219 still not served and not pollute the servers.
4220
4221 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
4222 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
4223 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
4224 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
4225 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
4226 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
4227 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
4228 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004229 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004230
4231 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4232 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4233
4234 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
4235
4236
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004237option accept-invalid-http-request
4238no option accept-invalid-http-request
4239 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
4240 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4241 yes | yes | yes | no
4242 Arguments : none
4243
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004244 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004245 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4246 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4247 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4248 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4249 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4250 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4251 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004252 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
4253 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
4254 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
4255 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
4256 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004257 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02004258 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
4259 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
4260 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004261
4262 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4263 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4264 been confirmed.
4265
4266 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4267 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004268 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
4269 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004270 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4271
4272 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4273 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4274
4275 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
4276 stats socket.
4277
4278
4279option accept-invalid-http-response
4280no option accept-invalid-http-response
4281 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
4282 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4283 yes | no | yes | yes
4284 Arguments : none
4285
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004286 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004287 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4288 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4289 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4290 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4291 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4292 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4293 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004294 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
4295 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
4296 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004297
4298 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4299 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4300 been confirmed.
4301
4302 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4303 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
4304 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
4305 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4306
4307 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4308 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4309
4310 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
4311 stats socket.
4312
4313
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004314option allbackups
4315no option allbackups
4316 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
4317 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4318 yes | no | yes | yes
4319 Arguments : none
4320
4321 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
4322 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
4323 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
4324 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
4325 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
4326 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
4327 order between the backup servers anymore.
4328
4329 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
4330 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
4331
4332 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4333 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4334
4335
4336option checkcache
4337no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08004338 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004339 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4340 yes | no | yes | yes
4341 Arguments : none
4342
4343 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
4344 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004345 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004346 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
4347 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004348 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004349
4350 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004351 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004352 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004353 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
4354 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004355 to the client are :
4356 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004357 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004358 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004359 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
4360 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
4361 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
4362 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
4363 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
4364 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
4365 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
4366 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
4367 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
4368 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
4369 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
4370
4371 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004372 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004373 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004374 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004375 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
4376
4377 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
4378 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004379 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004380 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
4381
4382 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4383 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4384
4385
4386option clitcpka
4387no option clitcpka
4388 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
4389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4390 yes | yes | yes | no
4391 Arguments : none
4392
4393 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4394 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4395 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4396 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4397
4398 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4399 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4400 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4401 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4402
4403 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4404 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4405 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4406 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4407 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4408
4409 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4410
4411 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4412 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4413 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
4414
4415 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4416 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4417
4418 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
4419
4420
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004421option contstats
4422 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
4423 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4424 yes | yes | yes | no
4425 Arguments : none
4426
4427 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
4428 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
4429 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
4430 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
4431 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
4432 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
4433 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
4434
4435
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004436option dontlog-normal
4437no option dontlog-normal
4438 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
4439 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4440 yes | yes | yes | no
4441 Arguments : none
4442
4443 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
4444 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
4445 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
4446 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
4447 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
4448 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
4449 logged.
4450
4451 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
4452 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
4453 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
4454
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004455 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004456 logging.
4457
4458
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004459option dontlognull
4460no option dontlognull
4461 Enable or disable logging of null connections
4462 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4463 yes | yes | yes | no
4464 Arguments : none
4465
4466 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
4467 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
4468 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
4469 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
4470 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
4471 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02004472 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
4473 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
4474 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004475
4476 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
4477 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
4478 would not be logged.
4479
4480 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4481 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4482
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02004483 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
4484 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004485
4486
4487option forceclose
4488no option forceclose
4489 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
4490 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01004491 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004492 Arguments : none
4493
4494 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
4495 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
4496 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
4497 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
4498 global session times in the logs.
4499
4500 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01004501 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004502 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004503
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004504 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
4505 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
4506 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
4507
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004508 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4509 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004510
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004511 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4512 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4513
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004514 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004515
4516
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004517option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004518 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
4519 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4520 yes | yes | yes | yes
4521 Arguments :
4522 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4523 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004524 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004525 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004526
4527 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
4528 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
4529 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
4530 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
4531 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
4532 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
4533 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004534 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
4535 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4536 possible that the client has already brought one.
4537
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004538 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004539 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004540 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
4541 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004542 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
4543 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004544
4545 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4546 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4547 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4548 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4549 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4550 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4551 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4552
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004553 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
4554 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
4555 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
4556 are under the control of the end-user.
4557
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004558 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004559 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4560 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004561 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
4562 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
4563 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004564
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004565 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004566 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
4567 frontend www
4568 mode http
4569 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
4570
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004571 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
4572 backend www
4573 mode http
4574 option forwardfor header X-Client
4575
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004576 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004577 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004578
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004579
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02004580option http-buffer-request
4581no option http-buffer-request
4582 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
4583 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4584 yes | yes | yes | yes
4585 Arguments : none
4586
4587 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
4588 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
4589 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
4590 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
4591 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
4592 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
4593 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
4594 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
4595 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbufferred transmissions between
4596 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
4597 default.
4598
4599 See also : "option http-no-delay"
4600
4601
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02004602option http-ignore-probes
4603no option http-ignore-probes
4604 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
4605 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4606 yes | yes | yes | no
4607 Arguments : none
4608
4609 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
4610 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
4611 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
4612 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
4613 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
4614 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
4615 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
4616 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
4617 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
4618 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
4619 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
4620 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
4621
4622 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
4623 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
4624 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
4625 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
4626 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
4627 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
4628 are often the only way to detect them.
4629
4630 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4631 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4632
4633 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
4634
4635
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004636option http-keep-alive
4637no option http-keep-alive
4638 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
4639 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4640 yes | yes | yes | yes
4641 Arguments : none
4642
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004643 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4644 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4645 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
4646 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
4647 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4648 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
4649 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
4650
4651 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
4652 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004653 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
4654 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
4655 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
4656 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
4657 situations where this option may be useful :
4658
4659 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
4660 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
4661
4662 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
4663 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
4664
4665 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
4666 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
4667 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
4668 request.
4669
4670 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
4671 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004672 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
4673 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
4674 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004675
4676 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
4677 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
4678
4679 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4680 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4681 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4682 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
4683 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4684 not set.
4685
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004686 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4687 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004688 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004689 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004690
4691 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004692 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
4693 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004694
4695
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004696option http-no-delay
4697no option http-no-delay
4698 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
4699 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4700 yes | yes | yes | yes
4701 Arguments : none
4702
4703 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
4704 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
4705 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
4706 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
4707 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
4708 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
4709 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
4710 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
4711 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
4712 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
4713 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
4714 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
4715 affected.
4716
4717 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
4718 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
4719 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
4720 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
4721 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
4722 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
4723 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
4724 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
4725 latency environments.
4726
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02004727 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
4728
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004729
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004730option http-pretend-keepalive
4731no option http-pretend-keepalive
4732 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
4733 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4734 yes | yes | yes | yes
4735 Arguments : none
4736
4737 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
4738 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
4739 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
4740 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
4741 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
4742 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
4743 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
4744 consider the response complete.
4745
4746 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
4747 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
4748 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
4749 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
4750 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
4751 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
4752
4753 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
4754 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
4755 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
4756 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
4757 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
4758 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
4759 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
4760
4761 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4762 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004763 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02004764 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
4765 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004766
4767 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4768 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4769
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004770 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
4771 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004772
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004773
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004774option http-server-close
4775no option http-server-close
4776 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
4777 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4778 yes | yes | yes | yes
4779 Arguments : none
4780
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004781 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4782 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4783 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4784 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4785 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4786 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
4787 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
4788 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
4789 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
4790 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
4791 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
4792 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
4793 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
4794 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
4795 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
4796 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004797
4798 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4799 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4800 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4801 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01004802 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4803 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004804
4805 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4806 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004807 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
4808 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004809 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
4810 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004811
4812 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4813 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4814
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004815 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004816 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4817 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004818
4819
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004820option http-tunnel
4821no option http-tunnel
4822 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
4823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4824 yes | yes | yes | yes
4825 Arguments : none
4826
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004827 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4828 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4829 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4830 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4831 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4832 "option http-tunnel".
4833
4834 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004835 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004836 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
4837 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
4838 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
4839 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
4840 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
4841 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
4842 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004843
4844 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4845 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4846
4847 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
4848 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4849 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
4850
4851
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004852option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004853no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004854 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
4855 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4856 yes | yes | yes | no
4857 Arguments : none
4858
4859 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
4860 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
4861 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
4862 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
4863 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
4864 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
4865 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
4866
4867 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
4868 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
4869 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
4870 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
4871 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
4872 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
4873 request along its whole life.
4874
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01004875 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
4876 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
4877 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
4878 front of an existing proxy.
4879
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004880 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
4881
4882 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
4883 http-server-close".
4884
4885
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004886option httpchk
4887option httpchk <uri>
4888option httpchk <method> <uri>
4889option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
4890 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
4891 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4892 yes | no | yes | yes
4893 Arguments :
4894 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
4895 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
4896 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
4897 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
4898 ones.
4899
4900 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
4901 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4902 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4903
4904 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4905 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4906 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4907 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4908 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4909
4910 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4911 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4912 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4913 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4914 the lack of any response.
4915
4916 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4917
4918 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4919 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4920 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4921
4922 Examples :
4923 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4924 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4925 backend https_relay
4926 mode tcp
4927 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4928 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4929
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004930 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4931 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4932 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004933
4934
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004935option httpclose
4936no option httpclose
4937 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4938 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4939 yes | yes | yes | yes
4940 Arguments : none
4941
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004942 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4943 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4944 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4945 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004946 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004947 "option http-tunnel".
4948
4949 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
4950 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
4951 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
4952 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
4953 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
4954 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
4955 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
4956 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004957
4958 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004959 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004960 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4961 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4962 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4963 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4964 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004965
4966 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4967 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004968 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
4969 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004970 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
4971 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004972
4973 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4974 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4975
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004976 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
4977 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004978
4979
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004980option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004981 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
4982 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4983 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004984 Arguments :
4985 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
4986 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
4987 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
4988 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
4989 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004990
4991 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4992 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4993 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
4994 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
4995 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
4996 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
4997 ports.
4998
4999 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5000
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01005001 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
5002 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005003
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005004 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005005
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005006
5007option http_proxy
5008no option http_proxy
5009 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
5010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5011 yes | yes | yes | yes
5012 Arguments : none
5013
5014 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
5015 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
5016 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
5017 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
5018 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
5019
5020 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
5021 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
5022 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
5023 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01005024 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005025 be analyzed.
5026
5027 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5028 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5029
5030 Example :
5031 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
5032 backend direct_forward
5033 option httpclose
5034 option http_proxy
5035
5036 See also : "option httpclose"
5037
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005038
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005039option independent-streams
5040no option independent-streams
5041 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005042 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5043 yes | yes | yes | yes
5044 Arguments : none
5045
5046 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
5047 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
5048 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
5049 receive data or not.
5050
5051 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
5052 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
5053 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
5054 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
5055 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
5056 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
5057 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
5058 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
5059 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
5060 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
5061 socket buffers.
5062
5063 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
5064 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
5065 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
5066 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
5067 slow lines, so use it with caution.
5068
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005069 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005070 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
5071 deprecated.
5072
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005073 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005074
5075
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02005076option ldap-check
5077 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
5078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5079 yes | no | yes | yes
5080 Arguments : none
5081
5082 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
5083 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
5084 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
5085 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
5086
5087 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
5088 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
5089
5090 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
5091 configure it.
5092
5093 Example :
5094 option ldap-check
5095
5096 See also : "option httpchk"
5097
5098
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005099option external-check
5100 Use external processes for server health checks
5101 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5102 yes | no | yes | yes
5103
5104 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
5105 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
5106 command".
5107
5108 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
5109
5110 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
5111
5112
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005113option log-health-checks
5114no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005115 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005116 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5117 yes | no | yes | yes
5118 Arguments : none
5119
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005120 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
5121 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
5122 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005123
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005124 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
5125 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
5126 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
5127 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
5128 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
5129
5130 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
5131 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005132
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005133 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
5134 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
5135 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005136
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005137
5138option log-separate-errors
5139no option log-separate-errors
5140 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
5141 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5142 yes | yes | yes | no
5143 Arguments : none
5144
5145 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
5146 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
5147 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
5148 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
5149 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
5150 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
5151 provides very important information.
5152
5153 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
5154 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
5155 error logs.
5156
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005157 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005158 logging.
5159
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005160
5161option logasap
5162no option logasap
5163 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
5164 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5165 yes | yes | yes | no
5166 Arguments : none
5167
5168 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
5169 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
5170 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
5171 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
5172 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
5173 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
5174 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005175 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005176 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
5177 bytes are expected to be transferred.
5178
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005179 Examples :
5180 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
5181 mode http
5182 option httplog
5183 option logasap
5184 log 192.168.2.200 local3
5185
5186 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
5187 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
5188 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
5189 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
5190
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005191 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005192 logging.
5193
5194
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005195option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005196 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005197 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5198 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005199 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005200 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
5201 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005202 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005203
5204 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
5205 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
5206 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
5207 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
5208 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
5209 in the MySQL table, like this :
5210
5211 USE mysql;
5212 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
5213 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
5214
5215 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
5216 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
5217 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
5218 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
5219 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
5220 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
5221 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
5222 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
5223 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
5224
5225 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
5226 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005227
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02005228 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005229
5230 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
5231 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
5232 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5233 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
5234 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
5235 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
5236
5237 See also: "option httpchk"
5238
5239
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005240option nolinger
5241no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005242 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005243 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5244 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005245 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005246
5247 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
5248 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
5249 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
5250 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
5251 connections.
5252
5253 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
5254 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
5255 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
5256 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
5257 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
5258 this too.
5259
5260 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
5261 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
5262 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
5263
5264 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
5265 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
5266 for servers.
5267
5268 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5269 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5270
5271
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005272option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
5273 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
5274 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5275 yes | yes | yes | yes
5276 Arguments :
5277 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5278 matching <network>
5279 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
5280 header name.
5281
5282 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
5283 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
5284 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
5285 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
5286 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
5287 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
5288 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
5289 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
5290 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5291 possible that the client has already brought one.
5292
5293 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
5294 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
5295 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
5296 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
5297 header and requires different one.
5298
5299 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5300 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5301 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5302 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5303 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5304 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5305 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5306
5307 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
5308 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5309 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
5310 both are defined.
5311
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005312 Examples :
5313 # Original Destination address
5314 frontend www
5315 mode http
5316 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
5317
5318 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
5319 backend www
5320 mode http
5321 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
5322
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005323 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
5324 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005325
5326
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005327option persist
5328no option persist
5329 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
5330 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5331 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005332 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005333
5334 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
5335 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
5336 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
5337 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
5338 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
5339 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
5340 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
5341 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
5342 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
5343 redirected to another valid server.
5344
5345 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5346 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5347
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005348 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005349
5350
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01005351option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
5352 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
5353 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5354 yes | no | yes | yes
5355 Arguments :
5356 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
5357 PostgreSQL server.
5358
5359 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
5360 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
5361 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
5362 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
5363
5364 See also: "option httpchk"
5365
5366
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005367option prefer-last-server
5368no option prefer-last-server
5369 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
5370 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5371 yes | no | yes | yes
5372 Arguments : none
5373
5374 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
5375 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
5376 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
5377 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
5378 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
5379 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
5380 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
5381 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
5382 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01005383 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
5384 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
5385 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
5386 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
5387 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
5388 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
5389 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005390
5391 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5392 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5393
5394 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
5395
5396
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005397option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07005398option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005399no option redispatch
5400 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5401 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5402 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07005403 Arguments :
5404 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
5405 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
5406 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
5407 N indicate a redispath is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
5408 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
5409 historical behaviour of redispatching on the last retry, a
5410 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
5411 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
5412 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
5413
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005414
5415 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5416 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5417 be able to access the service anymore.
5418
5419 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
5420 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
5421
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07005422 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005423 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5424 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005425
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005426 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
5427 "redisp" keywords.
5428
5429 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5430 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5431
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005432 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005433
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005434
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02005435option redis-check
5436 Use redis health checks for server testing
5437 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5438 yes | no | yes | yes
5439 Arguments : none
5440
5441 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
5442 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
5443 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
5444 find the "+PONG" response message.
5445
5446 Example :
5447 option redis-check
5448
5449 See also : "option httpchk"
5450
5451
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005452option smtpchk
5453option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
5454 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
5455 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5456 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005457 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005458 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
5459 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
5460 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
5461
5462 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
5463 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
5464 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
5465
5466 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
5467 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
5468 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
5469 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
5470 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
5471 dead server.
5472
5473 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
5474 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
5475 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
5476 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
5477
5478 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
5479 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
5480 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5481 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
5482 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
5483
5484 Example :
5485 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
5486
5487 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
5488
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005489
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02005490option socket-stats
5491no option socket-stats
5492
5493 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
5494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5495 yes | yes | yes | no
5496
5497 Arguments : none
5498
5499
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005500option splice-auto
5501no option splice-auto
5502 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
5503 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5504 yes | yes | yes | yes
5505 Arguments : none
5506
5507 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
5508 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
5509 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
5510 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005511 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005512 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
5513 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
5514 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
5515 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5516
5517 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
5518 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
5519 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
5520 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
5521 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
5522 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
5523 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
5524 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
5525 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
5526 keyword.
5527
5528 Example :
5529 option splice-auto
5530
5531 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5532 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5533
5534 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
5535 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5536
5537
5538option splice-request
5539no option splice-request
5540 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
5541 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5542 yes | yes | yes | yes
5543 Arguments : none
5544
5545 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005546 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005547 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5548 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5549 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5550 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5551
5552 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5553
5554 Example :
5555 option splice-request
5556
5557 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5558 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5559
5560 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
5561 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5562
5563
5564option splice-response
5565no option splice-response
5566 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
5567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5568 yes | yes | yes | yes
5569 Arguments : none
5570
5571 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005572 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005573 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5574 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5575 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5576 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5577
5578 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5579
5580 Example :
5581 option splice-response
5582
5583 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5584 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5585
5586 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
5587 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5588
5589
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005590option srvtcpka
5591no option srvtcpka
5592 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
5593 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5594 yes | no | yes | yes
5595 Arguments : none
5596
5597 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5598 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5599 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5600 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5601
5602 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5603 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5604 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5605 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5606
5607 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5608 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5609 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5610 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5611 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5612
5613 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5614
5615 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5616 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5617 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
5618
5619 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5620 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5621
5622 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
5623
5624
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005625option ssl-hello-chk
5626 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
5627 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5628 yes | no | yes | yes
5629 Arguments : none
5630
5631 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
5632 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
5633 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
5634 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
5635 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
5636 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
5637 hello message.
5638
5639 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
5640 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
5641 messages, which is appreciable.
5642
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005643 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
5644 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
5645 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005646
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005647 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
5648
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005649
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005650option tcp-check
5651 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
5652 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5653 yes | no | yes | yes
5654
5655 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
5656 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
5657
5658 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
5659 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
5660 attempt, which remains the default mode.
5661
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005662 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005663 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
5664 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
5665 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
5666 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
5667 only.
5668
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005669 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005670 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
5671 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
5672 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
5673 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
5674
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005675 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005676 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
5677 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005678 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005679 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
5680 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
5681 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
5682 the respective protocols.
5683 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
5684 analysed.
5685
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005686 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
5687 script.
5688
5689 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
5690 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
5691 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
5692 The "comment" is of course optional.
5693
5694
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005695 Examples :
5696 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
5697 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005698 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005699
5700 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
5701 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005702 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005703
5704 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
5705 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005706 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005707 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005708 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005709 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005710 tcp-check expect +PONGe
5711 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005712 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
5713 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005714 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005715 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
5716 tcp-check expect string +OK
5717
5718 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
5719 (send many headers before analyzing)
5720 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005721 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005722 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
5723 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
5724 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
5725 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005726 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005727
5728
5729 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
5730
5731
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005732option tcp-smart-accept
5733no option tcp-smart-accept
5734 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
5735 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5736 yes | yes | yes | no
5737 Arguments : none
5738
5739 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
5740 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
5741 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
5742 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
5743 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
5744 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
5745
5746 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
5747 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
5748 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
5749 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
5750
5751 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
5752 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
5753 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
5754 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
5755
5756 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
5757 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
5758 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
5759
5760 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
5761 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
5762 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
5763
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02005764 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
5765
5766
5767option tcp-smart-connect
5768no option tcp-smart-connect
5769 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
5770 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5771 yes | no | yes | yes
5772 Arguments : none
5773
5774 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
5775 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
5776 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
5777 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
5778 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
5779
5780 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
5781 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
5782 complex.
5783
5784 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
5785 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
5786 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
5787
5788 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5789 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5790
5791 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
5792
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005793
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005794option tcpka
5795 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
5796 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5797 yes | yes | yes | yes
5798 Arguments : none
5799
5800 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5801 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5802 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5803 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5804
5805 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5806 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5807 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5808 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5809
5810 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5811 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5812 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5813 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5814 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5815
5816 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5817
5818 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
5819 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
5820 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
5821 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
5822 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
5823 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
5824 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
5825 backends.
5826
5827 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
5828
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005829
5830option tcplog
5831 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
5832 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5833 yes | yes | yes | yes
5834 Arguments : none
5835
5836 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5837 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5838 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
5839 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
5840 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
5841 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
5842 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
5843 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
5844
5845 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5846
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005847 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005848
5849
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005850option transparent
5851no option transparent
5852 Enable client-side transparent proxying
5853 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01005854 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005855 Arguments : none
5856
5857 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
5858 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
5859 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
5860 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
5861 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
5862 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
5863 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
5864 appropriate server.
5865
5866 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
5867 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
5868
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01005869 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005870 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005871
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005872
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005873external-check command <command>
5874 Executable to run when performing an external-check
5875 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5876 yes | no | yes | yes
5877
5878 Arguments :
5879 <command> is the external command to run
5880
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005881 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
5882
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01005883 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005884
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01005885 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
5886 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
5887 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
5888 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
5889 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
5890 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005891
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01005892 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
5893
5894 Environment variables :
5895 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
5896 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
5897
5898 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
5899
5900 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
5901
5902 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
5903 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
5904 for a UNIX socket).
5905
5906 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
5907
5908 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
5909
5910 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
5911
5912 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
5913
5914 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
5915
5916 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
5917 socket).
5918
5919 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
5920 the command may be set using "external-check path".
5921
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005922 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
5923 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
5924 failed.
5925
5926 Example :
5927 external-check command /bin/true
5928
5929 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
5930
5931
5932external-check path <path>
5933 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
5934 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5935 yes | no | yes | yes
5936
5937 Arguments :
5938 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
5939
5940 The default path is "".
5941
5942 Example :
5943 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
5944
5945 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
5946 "external-check command"
5947
5948
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005949persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02005950persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005951 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
5952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5953 yes | no | yes | yes
5954 Arguments :
5955 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005956 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
5957 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005958
5959 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
5960 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
5961 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
5962 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
5963 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
5964 forwarded to this server.
5965
5966 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
5967 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
5968 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005969 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005970 a single "listen" section.
5971
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005972 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
5973 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
5974 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
5975
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005976 Example :
5977 listen tse-farm
5978 bind :3389
5979 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
5980 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5981 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
5982 # apply RDP cookie persistence
5983 persist rdp-cookie
5984 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005985 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005986 balance rdp-cookie
5987 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
5988 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
5989
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09005990 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
5991 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005992
5993
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005994rate-limit sessions <rate>
5995 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
5996 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5997 yes | yes | yes | no
5998 Arguments :
5999 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
6000 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
6001
6002 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
6003 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
6004 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
6005 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
6006 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
6007 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
6008
6009 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
6010 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
6011 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
6012 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
6013
6014 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
6015 listen smtp
6016 mode tcp
6017 bind :25
6018 rate-limit sessions 10
6019 server 127.0.0.1:1025
6020
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02006021 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
6022 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
6023 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006024
6025 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
6026
6027
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006028redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6029redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6030redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006031 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
6032 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6033 no | yes | yes | yes
6034
6035 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01006036 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006037
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006038 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006039 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006040 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
6041 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
6042 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006043
6044 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
6045 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
6046 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
6047 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
6048 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006049 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
6050 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
6051 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
6052 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006053
6054 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
6055 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
6056 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
6057 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
6058 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
6059 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006060 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006061 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006062 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
6063 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
6064 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006065
6066 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006067 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
6068 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
6069 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
6070 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
6071 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
6072 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
6073 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
6074 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006075
6076 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
6077 expected behaviour of a redirection :
6078
6079 - "drop-query"
6080 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
6081 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
6082 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
6083 with a location-type redirect.
6084
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006085 - "append-slash"
6086 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
6087 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
6088 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
6089 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
6090
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006091 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
6092 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
6093 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
6094 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
6095 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
6096 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
6097 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
6098
6099 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
6100 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
6101 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
6102 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
6103 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
6104 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
6105 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006106
6107 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
6108 acl clear dst_port 80
6109 acl secure dst_port 8080
6110 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006111 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006112 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006113 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
6114
6115 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006116 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
6117 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
6118 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006119 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006120
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006121 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
6122 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
6123 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
6124
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006125 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01006126 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006127
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006128 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
6129 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
6130 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
6131
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006132 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006133
6134
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006135redisp (deprecated)
6136redispatch (deprecated)
6137 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6138 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6139 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006140 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006141
6142 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6143 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6144 be able to access the service anymore.
6145
6146 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
6147 redistribute them to a working server.
6148
6149 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
6150 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6151 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006152
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006153 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
6154 "option redispatch" instead.
6155
6156 See also : "option redispatch"
6157
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006158
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006159reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006160 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
6161 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6162 no | yes | yes | yes
6163 Arguments :
6164 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6165 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006166 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006167
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006168 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6169 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6170
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006171 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6172 the last header of an HTTP request.
6173
6174 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6175 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6176 responses.
6177
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006178 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
6179 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
6180 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
6181
6182 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
6183 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006184
6185
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006186reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6187reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006188 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6189 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6190 no | yes | yes | yes
6191 Arguments :
6192 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6193 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6194 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6195 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6196 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6197 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
6198 ignores case.
6199
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006200 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6201 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6202
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006203 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6204 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
6205 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6206 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006207 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006208
6209 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6210 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6211
6212 Example :
6213 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
6214 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6215 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6216
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006217 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
6218 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006219
6220
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006221reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6222reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006223 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
6224 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6225 no | yes | yes | yes
6226 Arguments :
6227 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6228 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6229 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6230 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6231 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
6232 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
6233
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006234 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6235 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6236
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006237 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
6238 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
6239 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
6240 next servers.
6241
6242 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6243 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6244 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
6245
6246 Example :
6247 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
6248 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
6249 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
6250
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006251 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
6252 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006253
6254
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006255reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6256reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006257 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6258 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6259 no | yes | yes | yes
6260 Arguments :
6261 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6262 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6263 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6264 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6265 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6266 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
6267 case.
6268
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006269 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6270 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6271
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006272 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6273 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
6274 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6275 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006276 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006277
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006278 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006279 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006280 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006281
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006282 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6283 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6284
6285 Example :
6286 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
6287 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6288 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6289
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006290 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
6291 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006292
6293
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006294reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6295reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006296 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
6297 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6298 no | yes | yes | yes
6299 Arguments :
6300 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6301 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6302 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6303 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6304 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6305 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
6306 case.
6307
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006308 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6309 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6310
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006311 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6312 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
6313 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
6314 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6315
6316 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6317 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6318
6319 Example :
6320 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
6321 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
6322 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6323 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6324
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006325 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
6326 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006327
6328
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006329reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6330reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006331 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
6332 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6333 no | yes | yes | yes
6334 Arguments :
6335 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6336 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6337 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6338 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6339 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
6340 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
6341
6342 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6343 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
6344 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
6345 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006346 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006347
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006348 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6349 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6350
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006351 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
6352 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
6353 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
6354
6355 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6356 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6357 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
6358 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
6359 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6360
6361 Example :
6362 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006363 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006364 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
6365 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
6366
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04006367 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
6368 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006369
6370
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006371reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6372reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006373 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
6374 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6375 no | yes | yes | yes
6376 Arguments :
6377 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6378 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6379 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6380 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6381 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6382 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
6383 ignores case.
6384
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006385 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6386 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6387
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006388 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6389 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006390 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
6391 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
6392 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006393 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
6394 not set.
6395
6396 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
6397 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
6398 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
6399 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
6400 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
6401
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006402 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006403 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
6404 # block all others.
6405 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
6406 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
6407
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006408 # block bad guys
6409 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
6410 reqitarpit . if badguys
6411
6412 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
6413 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006414
6415
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02006416retries <value>
6417 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
6418 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6419 yes | no | yes | yes
6420 Arguments :
6421 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
6422 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
6423 default value is 3.
6424
6425 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
6426 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
6427 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
6428
6429 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006430 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
6431 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02006432
6433 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
6434 server even if a cookie references a different server.
6435
6436 See also : "option redispatch"
6437
6438
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006439rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006440 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
6441 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6442 no | yes | yes | yes
6443 Arguments :
6444 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6445 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006446 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006447
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006448 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6449 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6450
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006451 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6452 the last header of an HTTP response.
6453
6454 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6455 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6456 responses.
6457
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006458 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
6459 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006460
6461
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006462rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6463rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006464 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
6465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6466 no | yes | yes | yes
6467 Arguments :
6468 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6469 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6470 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6471 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6472 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6473 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
6474 ignores case.
6475
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006476 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6477 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6478
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006479 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
6480 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006481 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006482 client.
6483
6484 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6485 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6486 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
6487
6488 Example :
6489 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02006490 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006491
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006492 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
6493 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006494
6495
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006496rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6497rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006498 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
6499 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6500 no | yes | yes | yes
6501 Arguments :
6502 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6503 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6504 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6505 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6506 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6507 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
6508 ignores case.
6509
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006510 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6511 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6512
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006513 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6514 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
6515 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
6516 case-sensitive.
6517
6518 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006519 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
6520 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
6521 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006522
6523 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6524 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
6525
6526 Example :
6527 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
6528 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
6529
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006530 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
6531 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006532
6533
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006534rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6535rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006536 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
6537 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6538 no | yes | yes | yes
6539 Arguments :
6540 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6541 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6542 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6543 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6544 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6545 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
6546 ignores case.
6547
6548 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6549 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
6550 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
6551 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006552 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006553
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006554 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6555 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6556
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006557 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
6558 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
6559 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
6560
6561 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6562 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6563 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
6564 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
6565 are not case-sensitive.
6566
6567 Example :
6568 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
6569 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
6570
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006571 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
6572 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006573
6574
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01006575server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006576 Declare a server in a backend
6577 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6578 no | no | yes | yes
6579 Arguments :
6580 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02006581 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006582 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006583
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01006584 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
6585 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
6586 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
6587 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02006588 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
6589 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
6590 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
6591 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
6592 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006593 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
6594 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
6595 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
6596 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
6597 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6598 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6599 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006600 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006601 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
6602 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
6603 variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006604
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006605 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006606 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
6607 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
6608 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
6609 adding this value to the client's port.
6610
6611 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
6612 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006613 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006614
6615 Examples :
6616 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
6617 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006618 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006619 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
6620 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
6621 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006622
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006623 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
6624 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006625
6626
6627source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006628source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006629source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006630 Set the source address for outgoing connections
6631 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6632 yes | no | yes | yes
6633 Arguments :
6634 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
6635 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006636
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006637 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006638 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
6639 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
6640 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
6641 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
6642 supported prefixes are :
6643 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6644 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6645 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006646 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006647 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
6648 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006649
6650 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
6651 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006652 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
6653 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
6654 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006655
6656 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
6657 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
6658 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
6659 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
6660 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
6661 <addr>.
6662
6663 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
6664 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
6665 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
6666 port.
6667
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006668 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
6669 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
6670 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
6671 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01006672 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006673 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
6674 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
6675 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
6676 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
6677 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
6678 HTTP header.
6679
6680 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
6681 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006682 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006683 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
6684 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
6685 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
6686 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
6687 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
6688 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
6689 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
6690
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006691 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
6692 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
6693 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
6694 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
6695 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
6696 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
6697
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006698 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
6699 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
6700 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
6701 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
6702
6703 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
6704 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
6705 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
6706 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
6707 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
6708 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
6709
6710 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
6711 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
6712 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
6713 there are two methods :
6714
6715 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
6716 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
6717 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
6718 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
6719 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
6720 of the client ranges may be used.
6721
6722 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
6723 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
6724 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
6725 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
6726 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
6727 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
6728 same session.
6729
6730 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
6731 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
6732 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
6733 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
6734 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
6735 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
6736
6737 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
6738 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
6739 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006740 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006741
6742 Examples :
6743 backend private
6744 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
6745 source 192.168.1.200
6746
6747 backend transparent_ssl1
6748 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
6749 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6750
6751 backend transparent_ssl2
6752 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
6753 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
6754 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
6755
6756 backend transparent_ssl3
6757 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
6758 # is more conntrack-friendly.
6759 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6760
6761 backend transparent_smtp
6762 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
6763 # with Tproxy version 4.
6764 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
6765
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006766 backend transparent_http
6767 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
6768 # proxy.
6769 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
6770
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006771 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006772 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
6773
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006774
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006775srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6776 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6777 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6778 yes | no | yes | yes
6779 Arguments :
6780 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6781 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6782 as explained at the top of this document.
6783
6784 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6785 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6786 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6787 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6788 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6789 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6790 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6791
6792 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6793 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6794 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6795 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6796 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006797 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006798 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006799 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006800
6801 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6802 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6803 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6804 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6805 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6806 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6807
6808 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
6809 Please use "timeout server" instead.
6810
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006811 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
6812 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006813
6814
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006815stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
6816 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
6817 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006818 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006819
6820 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
6821 matched.
6822
6823 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
6824 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
6825
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006826 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6827 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6828 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6829
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01006830 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
6831 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
6832 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
6833 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006834
6835 Example :
6836 # statistics admin level only for localhost
6837 backend stats_localhost
6838 stats enable
6839 stats admin if LOCALHOST
6840
6841 Example :
6842 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
6843 backend stats_auth
6844 stats enable
6845 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
6846 stats admin if TRUE
6847
6848 Example :
6849 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
6850 userlist stats-auth
6851 group admin users admin
6852 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
6853 group readonly users haproxy
6854 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
6855
6856 backend stats_auth
6857 stats enable
6858 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
6859 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
6860 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
6861 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
6862
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006863 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
6864 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6865 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006866
6867
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006868stats auth <user>:<passwd>
6869 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
6870 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006871 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006872 Arguments :
6873 <user> is a user name to grant access to
6874
6875 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
6876
6877 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
6878 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
6879 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
6880 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
6881 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
6882 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
6883
6884 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
6885 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
6886 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006887 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006888
6889 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
6890 report using "stats scope".
6891
6892 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6893 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6894 unobvious parameters.
6895
6896 Example :
6897 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6898 backend public_www
6899 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6900 stats enable
6901 stats hide-version
6902 stats scope .
6903 stats uri /admin?stats
6904 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6905 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6906 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6907
6908 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6909 backend private_monitoring
6910 stats enable
6911 stats uri /admin?stats
6912 stats refresh 5s
6913
6914 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
6915
6916
6917stats enable
6918 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
6919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006920 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006921 Arguments : none
6922
6923 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
6924 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
6925 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
6926 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
6927 - stats auth : no authentication
6928 - stats scope : no restriction
6929
6930 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6931 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6932 unobvious parameters.
6933
6934 Example :
6935 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6936 backend public_www
6937 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6938 stats enable
6939 stats hide-version
6940 stats scope .
6941 stats uri /admin?stats
6942 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6943 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6944 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6945
6946 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6947 backend private_monitoring
6948 stats enable
6949 stats uri /admin?stats
6950 stats refresh 5s
6951
6952 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6953
6954
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006955stats hide-version
6956 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006957 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006958 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006959 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006960
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006961 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
6962 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
6963 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
6964 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
6965 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
6966 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006967
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006968 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6969 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6970 unobvious parameters.
6971
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006972 Example :
6973 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6974 backend public_www
6975 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006976 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006977 stats hide-version
6978 stats scope .
6979 stats uri /admin?stats
6980 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6981 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6982 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006983
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006984 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6985 backend private_monitoring
6986 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006987 stats uri /admin?stats
6988 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01006989
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006990 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006991
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006992
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02006993stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
6994 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6995 Access control for statistics
6996
6997 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6998 no | no | yes | yes
6999
7000 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
7001 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
7002 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
7003 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
7004 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
7005 should be asked to enter a username and password.
7006
7007 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
7008 instance.
7009
7010 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
7011 about ACL usage.
7012
7013
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007014stats realm <realm>
7015 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
7016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007017 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007018 Arguments :
7019 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
7020 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
7021 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
7022
7023 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
7024 using a backslash ('\').
7025
7026 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
7027 only related to authentication.
7028
7029 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7030 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7031 unobvious parameters.
7032
7033 Example :
7034 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7035 backend public_www
7036 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7037 stats enable
7038 stats hide-version
7039 stats scope .
7040 stats uri /admin?stats
7041 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7042 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7043 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7044
7045 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7046 backend private_monitoring
7047 stats enable
7048 stats uri /admin?stats
7049 stats refresh 5s
7050
7051 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
7052
7053
7054stats refresh <delay>
7055 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
7056 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007057 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007058 Arguments :
7059 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
7060 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
7061 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
7062 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
7063 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
7064 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
7065
7066 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
7067 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
7068 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
7069 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
7070
7071 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7072 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7073 unobvious parameters.
7074
7075 Example :
7076 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7077 backend public_www
7078 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7079 stats enable
7080 stats hide-version
7081 stats scope .
7082 stats uri /admin?stats
7083 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7084 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7085 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7086
7087 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7088 backend private_monitoring
7089 stats enable
7090 stats uri /admin?stats
7091 stats refresh 5s
7092
7093 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7094
7095
7096stats scope { <name> | "." }
7097 Enable statistics and limit access scope
7098 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007099 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007100 Arguments :
7101 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
7102 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
7103 section in which the statement appears.
7104
7105 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
7106 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
7107 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
7108 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
7109 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
7110 exists.
7111
7112 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7113 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7114 unobvious parameters.
7115
7116 Example :
7117 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7118 backend public_www
7119 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7120 stats enable
7121 stats hide-version
7122 stats scope .
7123 stats uri /admin?stats
7124 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7125 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7126 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7127
7128 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7129 backend private_monitoring
7130 stats enable
7131 stats uri /admin?stats
7132 stats refresh 5s
7133
7134 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7135
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007136
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007137stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007138 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
7139 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007140 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007141
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007142 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007143 description from global section is automatically used instead.
7144
7145 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7146 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
7147
7148 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7149 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007150 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007151
7152 Example :
7153 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7154 backend private_monitoring
7155 stats enable
7156 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
7157 stats uri /admin?stats
7158 stats refresh 5s
7159
7160 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
7161 global section.
7162
7163
7164stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007165 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
7166 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7167 yes | yes | yes | yes
7168 Arguments : none
7169
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007170 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007171 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
7172 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
7173 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
7174 - IP (socket, server)
7175 - cookie (backend, server)
7176
7177 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7178 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007179 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007180
7181 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
7182
7183
7184stats show-node [ <name> ]
7185 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
7186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007187 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007188 Arguments:
7189 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
7190 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
7191
7192 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7193 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007194 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007195
7196 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7197 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7198 unobvious parameters.
7199
7200 Example:
7201 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7202 backend private_monitoring
7203 stats enable
7204 stats show-node Europe-1
7205 stats uri /admin?stats
7206 stats refresh 5s
7207
7208 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
7209 section.
7210
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007211
7212stats uri <prefix>
7213 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
7214 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007215 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007216 Arguments :
7217 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
7218 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
7219 query string.
7220
7221 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
7222 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
7223 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
7224 possible to reach it in the application.
7225
7226 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007227 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007228 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
7229 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
7230 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
7231 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
7232
7233 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
7234 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
7235 an address or a port to statistics only.
7236
7237 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7238 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7239 unobvious parameters.
7240
7241 Example :
7242 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7243 backend public_www
7244 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7245 stats enable
7246 stats hide-version
7247 stats scope .
7248 stats uri /admin?stats
7249 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7250 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7251 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7252
7253 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7254 backend private_monitoring
7255 stats enable
7256 stats uri /admin?stats
7257 stats refresh 5s
7258
7259 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
7260
7261
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007262stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
7263 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007264 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007265 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007266
7267 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007268 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007269 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7270 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
7271 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
7272
7273 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7274 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7275 the "stick-table" statement.
7276
7277 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
7278 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
7279 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
7280 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
7281 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
7282
7283 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7284 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
7285 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
7286 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
7287 transformation rules.
7288
7289 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7290 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7291 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7292 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7293 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7294 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7295 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7296
7297 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
7298 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
7299 ACL based conditions.
7300
7301 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
7302 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
7303 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
7304 matches can be used as fallbacks.
7305
7306 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
7307 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
7308 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
7309 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
7310
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007311 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7312 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7313 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7314
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007315 Example :
7316 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7317 # last 30 minutes
7318 backend pop
7319 mode tcp
7320 balance roundrobin
7321 stick store-request src
7322 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7323 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
7324 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
7325
7326 backend smtp
7327 mode tcp
7328 balance roundrobin
7329 stick match src table pop
7330 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
7331 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
7332
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007333 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007334 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007335
7336
7337stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7338 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
7339 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7340 no | no | yes | yes
7341
7342 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
7343 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
7344 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
7345 for writing more maintainable configurations.
7346
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007347 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7348 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7349 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7350
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007351 Examples :
7352 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01007353 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007354
7355 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
7356 stick match src table pop if !localhost
7357 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
7358
7359
7360 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
7361 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
7362 backend http
7363 mode http
7364 balance roundrobin
7365 stick on src table https
7366 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
7367 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
7368 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
7369
7370 backend https
7371 mode tcp
7372 balance roundrobin
7373 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7374 stick on src
7375 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7376 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7377
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007378 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007379
7380
7381stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7382 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7383 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7384 no | no | yes | yes
7385
7386 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007387 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007388 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7389 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7390 server is selected.
7391
7392 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7393 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7394 the "stick-table" statement.
7395
7396 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7397 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7398 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
7399 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
7400 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
7401 address.
7402
7403 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7404 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
7405 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
7406 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
7407 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
7408 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
7409 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
7410 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
7411 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
7412 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
7413
7414 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7415 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7416 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7417 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7418 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7419 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7420 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7421
7422 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
7423 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7424 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
7425 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7426
7427 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
7428 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7429 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7430 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7431 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7432 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007433 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
7434 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7435 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7436 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7437 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7438 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007439
7440 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
7441 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
7442 the request.
7443
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007444 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7445 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7446 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7447
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007448 Example :
7449 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7450 # last 30 minutes
7451 backend pop
7452 mode tcp
7453 balance roundrobin
7454 stick store-request src
7455 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7456 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
7457 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
7458
7459 backend smtp
7460 mode tcp
7461 balance roundrobin
7462 stick match src table pop
7463 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
7464 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
7465
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007466 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007467 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007468
7469
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007470stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02007471 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
7472 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08007473 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007474 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007475 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007476
7477 Arguments :
7478 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
7479 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
7480 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
7481 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
7482
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01007483 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
7484 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
7485 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
7486 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
7487
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007488 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
7489 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
7490 instance.
7491
7492 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
7493 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
7494 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
7495 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
7496 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
7497 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007498 to 32 characters.
7499
7500 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
7501 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
7502 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007503 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007504 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
7505 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007506
7507 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007508 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
7509 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007510 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
7511 increase.
7512
7513 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007514 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
7515 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
7516 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007517
7518 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
7519 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
7520 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
7521 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
7522 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
7523 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
7524 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
7525 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
7526 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
7527 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
7528 parameter (see below).
7529
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02007530 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
7531 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
7532 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
7533 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
7534 soft restart.
7535
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02007536 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
7537 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007538
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007539 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
7540 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
7541 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
7542 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
7543 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007544 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007545 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
7546 if not expiration delay is specified.
7547
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007548 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
7549 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
7550 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
7551 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007552 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
7553 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
7554 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
7555 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
7556 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
7557 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
7558 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
7559 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
7560 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
7561 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
7562 types and their arguments.
7563
7564 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
7565 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
7566 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
7567 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
7568
7569 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
7570 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
7571 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
7572 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
7573
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02007574 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
7575 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
7576 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
7577 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
7578 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
7579 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
7580
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007581 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
7582 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
7583 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
7584 they were received.
7585
7586 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7587 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
7588 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
7589 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
7590 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
7591
7592 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7593 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7594 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7595 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
7596 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7597
7598 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
7599 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
7600 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
7601
7602 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7603 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7604 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7605 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
7606 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7607
7608 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7609 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
7610 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
7611 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
7612 the client side.
7613
7614 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7615 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7616 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7617 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
7618 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
7619 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
7620 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
7621
7622 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7623 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
7624 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
7625 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
7626 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
7627 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
7628 (eg: vulnerability scan).
7629
7630 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7631 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7632 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7633 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
7634 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
7635 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7636
7637 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7638 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
7639 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
7640 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
7641
7642 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7643 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7644 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7645 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7646 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7647 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
7648 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
7649 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
7650 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
7651 recommended for better fairness.
7652
7653 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7654 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
7655 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
7656 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
7657
7658 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
7659 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7660 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7661 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7662 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7663 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
7664 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
7665 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
7666 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
7667 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007668
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007669 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
7670 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007671 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
7672 reference it.
7673
7674 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
7675 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
7676 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
7677 as an exclusive stickiness.
7678
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007679 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
7680 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
7681 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
7682 something that can be ignored.
7683
7684 Example:
7685 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
7686 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
7687 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
7688 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
7689
7690 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01007691 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007692
7693
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007694stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7695 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7696 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7697 no | no | yes | yes
7698
7699 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007700 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007701 describes what elements of the response or connection will
7702 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7703 server is selected.
7704
7705 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7706 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7707 the "stick-table" statement.
7708
7709 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7710 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7711 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
7712 when the response is a SSL server hello.
7713
7714 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7715 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
7716 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
7717 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
7718 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
7719 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007720 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007721 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
7722 rules.
7723
7724 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7725 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7726 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7727 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7728 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7729 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7730 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7731
7732 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
7733 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7734 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
7735 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7736
7737 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
7738 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7739 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7740 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7741 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7742 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007743 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
7744 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7745 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7746 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7747 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7748 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
7749 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
7750 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
7751 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007752
7753 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
7754
7755 Example :
7756 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
7757 backend https
7758 mode tcp
7759 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007760 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007761 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007762
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007763 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
7764 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
7765
7766 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
7767 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7768 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
7769
7770 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
7771 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007772
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007773 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
7774 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
7775 # at offset 44.
7776
7777 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
7778 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
7779
7780 # Learn on response if server hello.
7781 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007782
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007783 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7784 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7785
7786 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
7787 extraction.
7788
7789
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02007790tcp-check connect [params*]
7791 Opens a new connection
7792 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7793 no | no | yes | yes
7794
7795 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
7796 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
7797 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
7798
7799 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
7800 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
7801 of the sequence.
7802
7803 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
7804 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
7805 do.
7806
7807 Parameters :
7808 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
7809 use the TCP connection.
7810
7811 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
7812 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
7813 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
7814
7815 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
7816
7817 ssl opens a ciphered connection
7818
7819 Examples:
7820 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
7821 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
7822 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
7823 option tcp-check
7824 tcp-check connect
7825 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7826 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7827 tcp-check send \r\n
7828 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7829 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
7830 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7831 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7832 tcp-check send \r\n
7833 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7834 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
7835
7836 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
7837 option tcp-check
7838 tcp-check connect port 110
7839 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7840 tcp-check connect port 143
7841 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7842 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
7843
7844 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
7845
7846
7847tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
7848 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
7849 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7850 no | no | yes | yes
7851
7852 Arguments :
7853 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
7854 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
7855 binary.
7856 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
7857 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
7858 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
7859
7860 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
7861 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
7862 with the usual backslash ('\').
7863 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
7864 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
7865 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
7866 used upper or lower case.
7867
7868
7869 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
7870
7871 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
7872 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7873 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
7874 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7875 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
7876 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
7877 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
7878 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
7879
7880 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
7881 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7882 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
7883 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7884 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
7885 expression.
7886
7887 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
7888 in the response buffer. A health check response will
7889 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
7890 this exact hexadecimal string.
7891 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
7892
7893 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
7894 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
7895 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
7896 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
7897 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
7898 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
7899 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
7900 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
7901 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
7902 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
7903 the null character.
7904
7905 Examples :
7906 # perform a POP check
7907 option tcp-check
7908 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7909
7910 # perform an IMAP check
7911 option tcp-check
7912 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7913
7914 # look for the redis master server
7915 option tcp-check
7916 tcp-check send PING\r\n
7917 tcp-check expect +PONG
7918 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7919 tcp-check expect string role:master
7920 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7921 tcp-check expect string +OK
7922
7923
7924 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
7925 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
7926
7927
7928tcp-check send <data>
7929 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7930 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7931 no | no | yes | yes
7932
7933 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7934 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7935
7936 Examples :
7937 # look for the redis master server
7938 option tcp-check
7939 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7940 tcp-check expect string role:master
7941
7942 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7943 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
7944
7945
7946tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
7947 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
7948 tcp health check
7949 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7950 no | no | yes | yes
7951
7952 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7953 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7954 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
7955 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
7956 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
7957 hexadecimal string.
7958 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
7959
7960 Examples :
7961 # redis check in binary
7962 option tcp-check
7963 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
7964 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
7965
7966
7967 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7968 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
7969
7970
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007971tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7972 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007973 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7974 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007975 Arguments :
7976 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007977 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
7978 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007979
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007980 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007981
7982 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
7983 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007984 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
7985 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
7986 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
7987 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
7988 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
7989 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007990
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007991 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
7992 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
7993 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
7994 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007995
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02007996 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007997 - accept :
7998 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7999 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8000 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008001
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008002 - reject :
8003 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8004 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8005 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
8006 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
8007 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
8008 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
8009 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
8010 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
8011 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
8012 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
8013 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
8014 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008015
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008016 - expect-proxy layer4 :
8017 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
8018 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
8019 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
8020 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
8021 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
8022 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
8023 hosts.
8024
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008025 - capture <sample> len <length> :
8026 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
8027 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
8028 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
8029 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
8030 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
8031 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
8032 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
8033 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008034 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
8035 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008036
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008037 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008038 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02008039 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008040 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008041 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
8042 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008043 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008044 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
8045 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
8046 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
8047 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
8048 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008049
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008050 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008051 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008052 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008053 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
8054 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
8055 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
8056 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008057
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008058 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
8059 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
8060 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
8061 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008062
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008063 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
8064 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
8065 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
8066 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
8067 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008068 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
8069 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
8070 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
8071 layer7 information is extracted.
8072
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008073 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
8074 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
8075 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
8076 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
8077 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008078
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008079 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
8080 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8081 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008082
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008083 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
8084 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
8085 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008086
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008087 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008088 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008089 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008090
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008091 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
8092 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
8093 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008094
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008095 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008096 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
8097 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008098
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008099 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
8100
8101 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
8102
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008103 See section 7 about ACL usage.
8104
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008105 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008106
8107
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008108tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8109 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008110 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008111 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008112 Arguments :
8113 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008114 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008115 "track-sc2", "capture" and "lua". See "tcp-request connection"
8116 above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008117
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008118 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008119
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008120 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
8121 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
8122 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
8123 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
8124 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008125
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008126 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
8127 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
8128 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
8129 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008130 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
8131 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
8132 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
8133 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
8134 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
8135 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008136 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008137 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008138
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008139 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
8140 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
8141 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
8142 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008143
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008144 Four types of actions are supported :
8145 - accept : the request is accepted
8146 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
8147 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008148 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008149
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008150 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
8151 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008152
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008153 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
8154 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
8155 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
8156 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
8157 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
8158 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008159
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008160 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008161 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8162 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008163
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008164 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02008165 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
8166 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
8167 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
8168 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008169 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
8170 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
8171 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008172
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008173 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008174 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
8175 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
8176 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008177
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008178 The "lua" keyword is followed by a Lua function name. It is used to run a Lua
8179 function if the action is executed. The single parameter is the name of the
8180 function to run. The prototype of the function is documented in the API
8181 documentation.
8182
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008183 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008184 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
8185 # and reject everything else.
8186 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
8187 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02008188 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008189 tcp-request content reject
8190
8191 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008192 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
8193 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
8194 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008195 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008196
8197 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
8198 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
8199 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008200 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008201 tcp-request content reject
8202
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008203 Example:
8204 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
8205 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008206 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008207
8208 Example:
8209 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
8210 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008211 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008212
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008213 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
8214 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
8215
8216 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008217 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008218 # protecting all our sites
8219 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008220 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
8221 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008222 ...
8223 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
8224
8225 backend http_dynamic
8226 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008227 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008228 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008229 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
8230 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
8231 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008232 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008233
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008234 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008235
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008236 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008237
8238
8239tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
8240 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
8241 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008242 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008243 Arguments :
8244 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8245 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8246 as explained at the top of this document.
8247
8248 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
8249 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
8250 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
8251 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
8252 data for at most the specified amount of time.
8253
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008254 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
8255 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
8256 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
8257 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
8258
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008259 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
8260 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008261 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008262 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01008263 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
8264 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
8265 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
8266 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008267
8268 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
8269 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
8270 it pass through unaffected.
8271
8272 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
8273 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
8274 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008275 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008276 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
8277 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02008278 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
8279 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
8280 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008281
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008282 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008283 "timeout client".
8284
8285
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008286tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8287 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
8288 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8289 no | no | yes | yes
8290 Arguments :
8291 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008292 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject", "lua".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008293
8294 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
8295
8296 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
8297 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
8298 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008299 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
8300 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008301
8302 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
8303
8304 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
8305 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
8306 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
8307 inserted.
8308
8309 Two types of actions are supported :
8310 - accept :
8311 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8312 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8313 the rules evaluation.
8314
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008315 - close :
8316 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
8317 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
8318 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
8319 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
8320 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
8321 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008322 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008323 protocols.
8324
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008325 - reject :
8326 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8327 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008328 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008329
8330 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
8331 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8332 for changing the default action to a reject.
8333
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008334 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
8335 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
8336 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
8337 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008338 period.
8339
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008340 The "lua" keyword is followed by a Lua function name. It is used to run a Lua
8341 function if the action is executed. The single parameter is the name of the
8342 function to run. The prototype of the function is documented in the API
8343 documentation.
8344
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008345 See section 7 about ACL usage.
8346
8347 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
8348
8349
8350tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
8351 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
8352 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8353 no | no | yes | yes
8354 Arguments :
8355 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8356 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8357 as explained at the top of this document.
8358
8359 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
8360
8361
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008362timeout check <timeout>
8363 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
8364 established.
8365
8366 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8367 yes | no | yes | yes
8368 Arguments:
8369 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8370 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8371 as explained at the top of this document.
8372
8373 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
8374 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
8375 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
8376 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01008377 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
8378 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
8379 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008380
8381 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
8382 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
8383
8384 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
8385 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008386 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008387
8388 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8389 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8390 forget about it.
8391
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008392 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
8393 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008394
8395
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008396timeout client <timeout>
8397timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8398 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
8399 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8400 yes | yes | yes | no
8401 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008402 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008403 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8404 as explained at the top of this document.
8405
8406 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
8407 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8408 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
8409 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
8410 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
8411 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
8412 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
8413 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008414 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008415 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008416 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
8417 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008418 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
8419 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008420
8421 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
8422 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8423 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8424 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8425 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8426 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8427
8428 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
8429 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
8430 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8431
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008432 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008433
8434
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008435timeout client-fin <timeout>
8436 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
8437 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8438 yes | yes | yes | no
8439 Arguments :
8440 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8441 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8442 as explained at the top of this document.
8443
8444 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
8445 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
8446 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
8447 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
8448 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
8449 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
8450 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
8451 down in one direction.
8452
8453 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
8454 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
8455 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
8456
8457 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
8458
8459
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008460timeout connect <timeout>
8461timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8462 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
8463 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8464 yes | no | yes | yes
8465 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008466 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008467 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8468 as explained at the top of this document.
8469
8470 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008471 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008472 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008473 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008474 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
8475 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008476
8477 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8478 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8479 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8480 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8481 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
8482 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8483
8484 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
8485 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
8486 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8487
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008488 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
8489 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008490
8491
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008492timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
8493 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
8494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8495 yes | yes | yes | yes
8496 Arguments :
8497 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8498 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8499 as explained at the top of this document.
8500
8501 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
8502 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
8503 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
8504 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
8505 once the request has started to present itself.
8506
8507 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
8508 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
8509 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
8510 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
8511 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
8512
8513 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
8514 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
8515 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
8516 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
8517
8518 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
8519 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
8520 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
8521 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
8522 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02008523 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008524
8525 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
8526 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
8527 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
8528 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
8529
8530 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
8531
8532
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008533timeout http-request <timeout>
8534 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
8535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02008536 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008537 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008538 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008539 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8540 as explained at the top of this document.
8541
8542 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
8543 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
8544 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
8545 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
8546 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
8547 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
8548 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02008549 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
8550 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
8551 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
8552 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
8553 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008554 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
8555 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008556
8557 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
8558 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008559 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
8560 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008561
8562 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
8563 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
8564 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
8565 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
8566 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
8567
8568 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02008569 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
8570 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
8571 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008572
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008573 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
8574 "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008575
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008576
8577timeout queue <timeout>
8578 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
8579 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8580 yes | no | yes | yes
8581 Arguments :
8582 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8583 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8584 as explained at the top of this document.
8585
8586 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
8587 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
8588 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
8589 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
8590 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
8591
8592 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
8593 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
8594 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
8595 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
8596
8597 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8598
8599
8600timeout server <timeout>
8601timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8602 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8603 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8604 yes | no | yes | yes
8605 Arguments :
8606 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8607 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8608 as explained at the top of this document.
8609
8610 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8611 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8612 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8613 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8614 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8615 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8616 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8617
8618 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8619 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8620 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8621 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8622 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008623 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008624 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008625 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
8626 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
8627 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
8628 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008629
8630 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8631 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8632 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8633 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8634 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8635 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8636
8637 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
8638 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
8639 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8640
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008641 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008642
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008643
8644timeout server-fin <timeout>
8645 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
8646 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8647 yes | no | yes | yes
8648 Arguments :
8649 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8650 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8651 as explained at the top of this document.
8652
8653 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8654 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
8655 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
8656 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
8657 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
8658 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
8659 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
8660 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
8661 situations, it should not be needed.
8662
8663 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8664 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
8665 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
8666
8667 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
8668
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008669
8670timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008671 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8673 yes | yes | yes | yes
8674 Arguments :
8675 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
8676 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8677 as explained at the top of this document.
8678
8679 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
8680 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
8681 defines how long it will be maintained open.
8682
8683 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8684 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8685 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
8686 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008687 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008688
8689 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8690
8691
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008692timeout tunnel <timeout>
8693 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
8694 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8695 yes | no | yes | yes
8696 Arguments :
8697 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8698 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8699 as explained at the top of this document.
8700
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008701 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008702 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
8703 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
8704 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
8705 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
8706 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
8707 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
8708 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
8709 specified.
8710
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008711 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
8712 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
8713 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
8714 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
8715 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
8716 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
8717 state.
8718
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008719 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8720 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8721 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
8722 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
8723 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
8724
8725 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8726 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8727 forget about it.
8728
8729 Example :
8730 defaults http
8731 option http-server-close
8732 timeout connect 5s
8733 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008734 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008735 timeout server 30s
8736 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
8737
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008738 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008739
8740
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008741transparent (deprecated)
8742 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8743 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008744 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008745 Arguments : none
8746
8747 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
8748 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8749 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8750 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8751 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8752 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8753 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8754 appropriate server.
8755
8756 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
8757
8758 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8759 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8760
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008761 See also: "option transparent"
8762
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008763unique-id-format <string>
8764 Generate a unique ID for each request.
8765 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8766 yes | yes | yes | no
8767 Arguments :
8768 <string> is a log-format string.
8769
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008770 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
8771 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
8772 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
8773 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008774
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008775 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
8776 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
8777 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
8778 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
8779 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
8780 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
8781 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
8782 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008783
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008784 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
8785 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008786
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008787 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008788
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008789 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008790
8791 will generate:
8792
8793 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8794
8795 See also: "unique-id-header"
8796
8797unique-id-header <name>
8798 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
8799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8800 yes | yes | yes | no
8801 Arguments :
8802 <name> is the name of the header.
8803
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008804 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
8805 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008806
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008807 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008808
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008809 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008810 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
8811
8812 will generate:
8813
8814 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8815
8816 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008817
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008818use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008819 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008820 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8821 no | yes | yes | no
8822 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008823 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
8824 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008825
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008826 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
8827 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008828
8829 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
8830 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
8831 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008832 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
8833 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
8834 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
8835 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008836
8837 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
8838 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
8839 assign the backend.
8840
8841 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
8842 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8843 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
8844 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
8845 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
8846 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
8847
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008848 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008849 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008850 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
8851 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
8852 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
8853
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008854 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
8855 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
8856 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
8857 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
8858 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
8859 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
8860 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
8861 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
8862 cannot be forced from the request.
8863
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008864 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008865 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
8866 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
8867
8868 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
8869 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008870
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008871
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008872use-server <server> if <condition>
8873use-server <server> unless <condition>
8874 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
8875 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8876 no | no | yes | yes
8877 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008878 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008879
8880 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
8881
8882 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
8883 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
8884 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
8885
8886 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
8887 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
8888 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
8889 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
8890 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
8891 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
8892 matches will assign the server.
8893
8894 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
8895 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
8896 with the next rules until one matches.
8897
8898 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
8899 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8900 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
8901 according to other persistence mechanisms.
8902
8903 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
8904 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
8905 stripped.
8906
8907 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
8908 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
8909 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
8910 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
8911
8912 Example :
8913 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
8914 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
8915 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
8916 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
8917 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
8918 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
8919 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
8920 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
8921 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
8922
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008923 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008924
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008925
89265. Bind and Server options
8927--------------------------
8928
8929The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
8930depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
8931settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
8932written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
8933described in this section.
8934
8935
89365.1. Bind options
8937-----------------
8938
8939The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
8940as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
8941no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
8942parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
8943while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
8944provided immediately after the setting name.
8945
8946The currently supported settings are the following ones.
8947
8948accept-proxy
8949 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02008950 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
8951 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008952 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
8953 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
8954 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
8955 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
8956 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
8957 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
8958 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008959 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
8960 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008961
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008962alpn <protocols>
8963 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
8964 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
8965 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
8966 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
8967 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
8968 initial NPN extension.
8969
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008970backlog <backlog>
8971 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
8972 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
8973
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008974ecdhe <named curve>
8975 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01008976 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
8977 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008978
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008979ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008980 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8981 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8982 client's certificate.
8983
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008984ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
8985 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8986 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
8987 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
8988 error is ignored.
8989
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008990ciphers <ciphers>
8991 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
8992 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008993 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008994 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
8995 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
8996
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008997crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008998 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8999 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
9000 to verify client's certificate.
9001
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009002crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009003 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9004 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
9005 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
9006 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
9007 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
9008 file.
9009
9010 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
9011 are loaded.
9012
9013 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01009014 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01009015 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
9016 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
9017 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
9018 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
9019 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
9020 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
9021 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009022
9023 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
9024 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
9025 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
9026 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01009027 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
9028 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009029
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02009030 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009031
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009032 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
9033 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08009034 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009035 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
9036 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
9037 clients).
9038
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02009039 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
9040 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
9041 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
9042 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
9043 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
9044 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
9045 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
9046 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
9047 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
9048 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
9049 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
9050 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
9051 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
9052
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01009053 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
9054 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
9055 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
9056 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
9057 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
9058
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009059crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009060 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
9061 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009062 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009063 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009064
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009065crt-list <file>
9066 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009067 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
9068 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009069
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009070 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009071
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009072 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
9073 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
9074 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
9075 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
9076 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
9077 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
9078 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
9079 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009080
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009081defer-accept
9082 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
9083 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
9084 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
9085 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
9086 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
9087 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
9088 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
9089 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
9090 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
9091 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
9092 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
9093
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009094force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009095 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009096 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009097 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
9098 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009099
9100force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009101 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009102 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9103 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009104
9105force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009106 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009107 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9108 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009109
9110force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009111 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009112 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9113 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009114
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009115gid <gid>
9116 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
9117 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9118 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
9119 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
9120 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9121
9122group <group>
9123 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
9124 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
9125 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
9126 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
9127 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9128
9129id <id>
9130 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
9131 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
9132 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
9133 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
9134
9135interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01009136 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
9137 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
9138 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
9139 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
9140 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
9141 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
9142 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009143
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02009144level <level>
9145 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
9146 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
9147 sockets. <level> can be one of :
9148 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
9149 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
9150 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
9151 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
9152 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
9153 counters).
9154 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
9155 all counters).
9156
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009157maxconn <maxconn>
9158 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
9159 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
9160 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
9161 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
9162 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
9163 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
9164 eat all memory.
9165
9166mode <mode>
9167 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
9168 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
9169 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
9170 UNIX sockets.
9171
9172mss <maxseg>
9173 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
9174 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
9175 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
9176 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
9177 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
9178 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
9179 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
9180 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
9181 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
9182 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
9183 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
9184
9185name <name>
9186 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
9187 page.
9188
9189nice <nice>
9190 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
9191 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
9192 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
9193 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
9194 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
9195 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
9196 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
9197 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
9198 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
9199 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
9200 one for an RDP socket.
9201
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009202no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009203 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009204 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009205 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009206 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
9207 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009208 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009209
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02009210no-tls-tickets
9211 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9212 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
9213 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009214 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
9215 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02009216
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009217no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009218 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009219 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009220 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009221 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9222 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9223 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009224
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009225no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009226 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009227 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009228 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009229 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9230 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9231 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009232
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009233no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009234 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009235 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009236 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009237 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9238 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9239 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009240
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02009241npn <protocols>
9242 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
9243 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
9244 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
9245 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02009246 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
9247 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02009248
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02009249process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
9250 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
9251 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
9252 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
9253 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
9254 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
9255 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
9256 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +02009257 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
9258 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
9259 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
9260 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
9261 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
9262 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
9263 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02009264
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009265ssl
9266 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009267 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009268 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
9269 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
9270 to deciphered contents.
9271
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01009272strict-sni
9273 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
9274 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
9275 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
9276 See the "crt" option for more information.
9277
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +01009278tcp-ut <delay>
9279 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instanciated from this
9280 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
9281 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
9282 receiving an acknoledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
9283 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
9284 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
9285 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
9286 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
9287 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
9288 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
9289 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
9290
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009291tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01009292 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009293 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
9294 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
9295 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
9296 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
9297 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
9298 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
9299 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02009300 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
9301 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
9302 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009303
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +01009304tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
9305 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
9306 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
9307 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
9308 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
9309 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
9310 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
9311 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
9312 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
9313 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
9314 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
9315
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009316transparent
9317 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
9318 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
9319 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
9320 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
9321 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
9322 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
9323 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
9324 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
9325 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
9326 so check for support with your vendor.
9327
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009328v4v6
9329 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
9330 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
9331 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
9332 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009333 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009334
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01009335v6only
9336 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
9337 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
9338 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009339 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
9340 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01009341
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009342uid <uid>
9343 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
9344 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9345 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
9346 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
9347 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9348
9349user <user>
9350 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
9351 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9352 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
9353 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
9354 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9355
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009356verify [none|optional|required]
9357 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
9358 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
9359 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
9360 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
9361 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009362 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
9363 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
9364 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
9365 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009366
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020093675.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009368------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009369
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01009370The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
9371which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
9372arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
9373settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
9374after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
9375Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
9376address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009377
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009378 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01009379 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009380
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009381The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009382
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009383addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009384 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
9385 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
9386 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
9387 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
9388 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009389
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009390 Supported in default-server: No
9391
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009392agent-check
9393 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009394 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
9395 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
9396 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
9397 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009398
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009399 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009400 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +02009401 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
9402 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
9403 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009404
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009405 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9406 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009407
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009408 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9409 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
9410 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009411
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009412 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9413 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
9414 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009415
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009416 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
9417 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
9418 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
9419 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
9420 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
9421 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
9422 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009423
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009424 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
9425 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009426
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009427 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
9428 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
9429 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
9430 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
9431 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
9432 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
9433 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
9434 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
9435 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009436
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09009437 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
9438 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009439 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
9440 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
9441 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
9442 force an agent's result in order to workaround a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09009443
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009444 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
9445 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009446
9447 Supported in default-server: No
9448
9449agent-inter <delay>
9450 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
9451 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
9452
9453 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
9454 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
9455 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
9456 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
9457 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
9458 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
9459 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
9460 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
9461 of backends use the same servers.
9462
9463 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
9464
9465 Supported in default-server: Yes
9466
9467agent-port <port>
9468 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
9469
9470 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
9471
9472 Supported in default-server: Yes
9473
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009474backup
9475 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
9476 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
9477 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
9478 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
9479 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
9480 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009481
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009482 Supported in default-server: No
9483
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009484ca-file <cafile>
9485 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9486 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
9487 server's certificate.
9488
9489 Supported in default-server: No
9490
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009491check
9492 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01009493 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
9494 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
9495 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
9496 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
9497 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
9498 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
9499 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09009500 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
9501 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
9502 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009503
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009504 Supported in default-server: No
9505
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02009506check-send-proxy
9507 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
9508 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
9509 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
9510 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
9511 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
9512 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
9513 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
9514
9515 Supported in default-server: No
9516
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009517check-ssl
9518 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
9519 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
9520 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
9521 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009522 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009523 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
9524 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
9525 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
9526 See the "ssl" option for more information.
9527
9528 Supported in default-server: No
9529
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009530ciphers <ciphers>
9531 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009532 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009533 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
9534 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
9535 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
9536 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
9537 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
9538 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
9539
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009540 Supported in default-server: No
9541
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009542cookie <value>
9543 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
9544 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
9545 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
9546 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
9547 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
9548 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
9549 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
9550
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009551 Supported in default-server: No
9552
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009553crl-file <crlfile>
9554 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9555 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
9556 to verify server's certificate.
9557
9558 Supported in default-server: No
9559
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02009560crt <cert>
9561 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
9562 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
9563 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
9564 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
9565 certificate request.
9566
9567 Supported in default-server: No
9568
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02009569disabled
9570 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
9571 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
9572 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
9573 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
9574 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
9575
9576 Supported in default-server: No
9577
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009578error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009579 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
9580 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
9581 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009582
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009583 Supported in default-server: Yes
9584
9585 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009586
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009587fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009588 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
9589 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
9590 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
9591
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009592 Supported in default-server: Yes
9593
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009594force-sslv3
9595 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
9596 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009597 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
9598 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009599
9600 Supported in default-server: No
9601
9602force-tlsv10
9603 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009604 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9605 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009606
9607 Supported in default-server: No
9608
9609force-tlsv11
9610 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009611 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9612 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009613
9614 Supported in default-server: No
9615
9616force-tlsv12
9617 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009618 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9619 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009620
9621 Supported in default-server: No
9622
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009623id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02009624 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
9625 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
9626 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009627
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009628 Supported in default-server: No
9629
9630inter <delay>
9631fastinter <delay>
9632downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009633 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
9634 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
9635 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
9636 between checks depending on the server state :
9637
9638 Server state | Interval used
9639 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9640 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
9641 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9642 Transitionally UP (going down), |
9643 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
9644 or yet unchecked. |
9645 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9646 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
9647 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009648
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009649 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
9650 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
9651 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
9652 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009653 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
9654 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
9655 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
9656 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
9657 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009658
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009659 Supported in default-server: Yes
9660
9661maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009662 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
9663 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
9664 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
9665 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
9666 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
9667 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
9668 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
9669 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
9670
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009671 Supported in default-server: Yes
9672
9673maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009674 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
9675 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
9676 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
9677 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
9678 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
9679 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
9680 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
9681
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009682 Supported in default-server: Yes
9683
9684minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009685 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
9686 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
9687 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
9688 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
9689 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
9690 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009691 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009692 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009693
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009694 Supported in default-server: Yes
9695
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +01009696no-ssl-reuse
9697 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
9698 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
9699 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
9700 and for paranoid users.
9701
9702 Supported in default-server: No
9703
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009704no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009705 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
9706 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009707 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009708
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009709 Supported in default-server: No
9710
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009711no-tls-tickets
9712 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9713 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
9714 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009715 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
9716 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009717
9718 Supported in default-server: No
9719
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009720no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009721 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009722 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9723 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009724 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9725 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9726 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009727
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009728 Supported in default-server: No
9729
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009730no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009731 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009732 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9733 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009734 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9735 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9736 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009737
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009738 Supported in default-server: No
9739
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009740no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009741 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009742 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9743 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009744 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9745 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9746 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009747
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009748 Supported in default-server: No
9749
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09009750non-stick
9751 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
9752 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
9753 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
9754
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009755 Supported in default-server: No
9756
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009757observe <mode>
9758 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
9759 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
9760 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
9761 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
9762 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
9763 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01009764 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009765
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009766 Supported in default-server: No
9767
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009768 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
9769
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009770on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009771 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
9772 Currently, four modes are available:
9773 - fastinter: force fastinter
9774 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
9775 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
9776 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
9777 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
9778
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009779 Supported in default-server: Yes
9780
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009781 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
9782
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009783on-marked-down <action>
9784 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
9785 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009786 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
9787 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
9788 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
9789 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
9790 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
9791 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
9792 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
9793 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009794
9795 Actions are disabled by default
9796
9797 Supported in default-server: Yes
9798
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009799on-marked-up <action>
9800 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
9801 Currently one action is available:
9802 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
9803 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
9804 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
9805 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
9806 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
9807 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
9808 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
9809 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
9810
9811 Actions are disabled by default
9812
9813 Supported in default-server: Yes
9814
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009815port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009816 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
9817 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
9818 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
9819 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
9820 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
9821 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
9822
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009823 Supported in default-server: Yes
9824
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009825redir <prefix>
9826 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
9827 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
9828 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
9829 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
9830 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
9831 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
9832 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
9833 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009834 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009835 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
9836 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
9837 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
9838 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
9839 loop between the client and HAProxy!
9840
9841 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
9842
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009843 Supported in default-server: No
9844
9845rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009846 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
9847 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
9848 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
9849
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009850 Supported in default-server: Yes
9851
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009852send-proxy
9853 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
9854 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
9855 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
9856 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
9857 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
9858 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
9859 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
9860 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
9861 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02009862 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
9863 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
9864 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
9865 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
9866 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009867
9868 Supported in default-server: No
9869
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -04009870send-proxy-v2
9871 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
9872 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9873 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9874 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9875 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
9876 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
9877 option of the "bind" keyword.
9878
9879 Supported in default-server: No
9880
9881send-proxy-v2-ssl
9882 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9883 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9884 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9885 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9886 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9887 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
9888 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
9889 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9890
9891 Supported in default-server: No
9892
9893send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
9894 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9895 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9896 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9897 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9898 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9899 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
9900 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
9901 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
9902 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9903
9904 Supported in default-server: No
9905
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009906slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009907 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
9908 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
9909 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
9910 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
9911 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
9912 parameters :
9913
9914 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
9915 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
9916
9917 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
9918 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
9919 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
9920 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
9921
9922 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
9923 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
9924 seen as failed.
9925
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009926 Supported in default-server: Yes
9927
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009928source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009929source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009930source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009931 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
9932 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
9933 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
9934 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
9935
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009936 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
9937 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
9938 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
9939 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
9940 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
9941 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
9942 server.
9943
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009944 Supported in default-server: No
9945
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009946ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009947 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
9948 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
9949 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
9950 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
9951 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
9952 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009953 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009954
9955 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009956
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009957track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +02009958 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
9959 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
9960 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
9961 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009962 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
9963
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009964 Supported in default-server: No
9965
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009966verify [none|required]
9967 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01009968 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
9969 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
9970 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
9971 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009972 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
9973 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
9974 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009975
9976 Supported in default-server: No
9977
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07009978verifyhost <hostname>
9979 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
9980 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
9981 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
9982 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
9983 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
9984 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
9985
9986 Supported in default-server: No
9987
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009988weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009989 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
9990 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
9991 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02009992 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
9993 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
9994 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
9995 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
9996 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
9997 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009998
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009999 Supported in default-server: Yes
10000
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010001
100026. HTTP header manipulation
10003---------------------------
10004
10005In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
10006response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
10007request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
10008which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010010009against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010010
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010010011If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
10012to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
10013but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
10014HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
10015stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
10016because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
10017a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
10018still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020010019
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010020This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
10021in section 4.2 :
10022
10023 - reqadd <string>
10024 - reqallow <search>
10025 - reqiallow <search>
10026 - reqdel <search>
10027 - reqidel <search>
10028 - reqdeny <search>
10029 - reqideny <search>
10030 - reqpass <search>
10031 - reqipass <search>
10032 - reqrep <search> <replace>
10033 - reqirep <search> <replace>
10034 - reqtarpit <search>
10035 - reqitarpit <search>
10036 - rspadd <string>
10037 - rspdel <search>
10038 - rspidel <search>
10039 - rspdeny <search>
10040 - rspideny <search>
10041 - rsprep <search> <replace>
10042 - rspirep <search> <replace>
10043
10044With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
10045is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
10046parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
10047prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
10048Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
10049
10050 \t for a tab
10051 \r for a carriage return (CR)
10052 \n for a new line (LF)
10053 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
10054 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
10055 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
10056 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
10057 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
10058
10059The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
10060portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
10061above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
10062regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
100639 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
10064is very common to users of the "sed" program.
10065
10066The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
10067after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
10068
10069Notes related to these keywords :
10070---------------------------------
10071 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
10072 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
10073 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
10074
10075 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
10076 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
10077 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
10078
10079 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
10080 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
10081 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
10082 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
10083 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
10084
10085 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
10086 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
10087 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
10088 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
10089 useless headers before adding new ones.
10090
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010091 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010092 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
10093
10094 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
10095 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
10096 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
10097
10098 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
10099 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010100 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010101
10102
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200101037. Using ACLs and fetching samples
10104----------------------------------
10105
10106Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
10107client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
10108The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
10109these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
10110but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
10111data called patterns.
10112
10113
101147.1. ACL basics
10115---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010116
10117The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
10118content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
10119from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
10120simple :
10121
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010122 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010123 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010124 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
10125 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010126
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010127The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
10128adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010129
10130In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
10131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010132 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010133
10134This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
10135Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
10136and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010137an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
10138conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
10139as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
10140are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010141
10142ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
10143'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
10144which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
10145
10146There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
10147performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
10148
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010149The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
10150specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
10151this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010152methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
10153ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010154
10155Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
10156 - boolean
10157 - integer (signed or unsigned)
10158 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
10159 - string
10160 - data block
10161
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010162Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
10163converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
10164would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
10165The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
10166which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
10167
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010168Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
10169keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
10170fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
10171which are summarized in the table below :
10172
10173 +---------------------+-----------------+
10174 | Sample or converter | Default |
10175 | output type | matching method |
10176 +---------------------+-----------------+
10177 | boolean | bool |
10178 +---------------------+-----------------+
10179 | integer | int |
10180 +---------------------+-----------------+
10181 | ip | ip |
10182 +---------------------+-----------------+
10183 | string | str |
10184 +---------------------+-----------------+
10185 | binary | none, use "-m" |
10186 +---------------------+-----------------+
10187
10188Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
10189matching method, see below.
10190
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010191The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
10192 - boolean
10193 - integer or integer range
10194 - IP address / network
10195 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
10196 - regular expression
10197 - hex block
10198
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010199The following ACL flags are currently supported :
10200
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010201 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
10202 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010203 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010010204 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010010205 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010010206 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010207 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
10208
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010209The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
10210read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
10211if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
10212lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
10213will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
10214beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
10215a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
10216lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
10217exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
10218
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010010219The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
10220parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
10221ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
10222a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
10223check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
10224
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010010225The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
10226socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
10227file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
10228
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010229Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
10230loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
10231
10232 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
10233
10234In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
10235the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
10236case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
10237as well.
10238
10239The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
10240sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
10241do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
10242methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
10243is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
10244obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
10245followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
10246default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
10247that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
10248string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
10249
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010010250The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
10251By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
10252string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
10253resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
10254server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
10255waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
10256flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
10257function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
10258
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010259There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
10260sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
10261be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010262
10263 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
10264 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010265 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
10266 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
10267 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
10268 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010269
10270 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
10271 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010272 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010273
10274 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010275 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010276
10277 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010278 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010279
10280 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
10281 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
10282
10283 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
10284 binary or string samples.
10285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010286 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
10287 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010288
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010289 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
10290 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
10291 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010292
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010293 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
10294 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010296 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
10297 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010298
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010299 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
10300 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010301
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010302 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
10303 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010304 This may be used with binary or string samples.
10305
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010306 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
10307 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
10308 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010309
10310For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
10311request, it is possible to do :
10312
10313 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
10314
10315In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
10316buffer, one would use the following acl :
10317
10318 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
10319
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010320On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
10321possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
10322
10323 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
10324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010325All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
10326criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
10327method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
10328to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
10329criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
10330the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010331
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010332If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010333the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
10334For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010335
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010336 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
10337 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
10338 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
10339 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010340
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010341
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010342The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
10343types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
10344combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
10345brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
10346default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010347
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010348 +-------------------------------------------------+
10349 | Input sample type |
10350 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010351 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010352 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
10353 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
10354 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010355 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010356 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010357 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010358 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010359 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010360 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010361 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010362 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010363 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010364 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010365 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010366 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010367 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010368 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010369 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010370 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010371 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010372 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010373 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010374 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010375 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010376 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
10377 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
10378 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010379
10380
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200103817.1.1. Matching booleans
10382------------------------
10383
10384In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
10385Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
10386When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
10387that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
10388
10389Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
10390return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
10391"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
10392
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010393
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200103947.1.2. Matching integers
10395------------------------
10396
10397Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
10398enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
10399to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
10400
10401Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
10402matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
10403lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010404
10405For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
10406unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
10407representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
10408
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010409As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
10410two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
10411instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
10412ranges and operators.
10413
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010414For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010415operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
10416Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
10417of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010418
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010419Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010420
10421 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
10422 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
10423 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
10424 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
10425 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
10426
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010427For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010428
10429 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
10430
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010431This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
10432
10433 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
10434
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010435
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200104367.1.3. Matching strings
10437-----------------------
10438
10439String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
10440different forms :
10441
10442 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
10443 patterns ;
10444
10445 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
10446 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
10447
10448 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
10449 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
10450
10451 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
10452 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
10453
10454 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
10455 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
10456 matches.
10457
10458 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
10459 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
10460 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010461
10462String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
10463exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
10464characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
10465string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
10466to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010467before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010468
10469
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200104707.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
10471---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010472
10473Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
10474they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
10475possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
10476passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
10477the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010478the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
10479match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010480
10481
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200104827.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
10483-------------------------------------
10484
10485It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
10486not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
10487a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
10488to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
10489digits may be used upper or lower case.
10490
10491Example :
10492 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
10493 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
10494
10495
104967.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
10497---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010498
10499IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
10500netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
10501within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010502host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010503difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
10504at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
10505does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
10506parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010507
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020010508IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
10509Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
10510trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
10511IPv6 patterns.
10512
10513HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
10514following situations :
10515 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
10516 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
10517 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
10518 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
10519 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
10520 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
10521 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
10522 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
10523 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
10524 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
10525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010526
105277.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
10528----------------------------------
10529
10530Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
10531combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
10532
10533 - AND (implicit)
10534 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
10535 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010536
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010537A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010538
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010539 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020010540
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010541Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
10542indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020010543
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010544For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
10545"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
10546requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
10547is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
10548
10549 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
10550 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
10551 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
10552 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
10553
10554To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
10555and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
10556
10557 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
10558 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
10559 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
10560 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
10561
10562 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
10563 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
10564 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
10565 use_backend www if host_www
10566
10567It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
10568expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
10569be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
10570the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
10571
10572 The following rule :
10573
10574 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
10575 block if METH_POST missing_cl
10576
10577 Can also be written that way :
10578
10579 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
10580
10581It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
10582to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
10583simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
10584sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
10585good use is the following :
10586
10587 With named ACLs :
10588
10589 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
10590 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
10591 monitor fail if site_dead
10592
10593 With anonymous ACLs :
10594
10595 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
10596
10597See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
10598
10599
106007.3. Fetching samples
10601---------------------
10602
10603Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
10604against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
10605sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
10606ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
10607of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
10608available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
10609
10610This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
10611Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
10612compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
10613deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
10614
10615The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
10616matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
10617method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
10618indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
10619
10620As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
10621when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
10622mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
10623the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
10624ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
10625
10626Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
10627multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
10628when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
10629incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
10630are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
10631is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
10632all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
10633
10634Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
10635 - name
10636 - name(arg1)
10637 - name(arg1,arg2)
10638
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010639
106407.3.1. Converters
10641-----------------
10642
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010643Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
10644of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
10645is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
10646was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
10647has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
10648unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
10649
10650These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
10651sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
10652the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
10653support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010654
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010655A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
10656support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
10657supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
10658(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
10659bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
10660
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010661The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010662
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010663add(<value>)
10664 Adds <value> to the input value of type unsigned integer, and returns the
10665 result as an unsigned integer.
10666
10667and(<value>)
10668 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type unsigned
10669 integer, and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
10670
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020010671base64
10672 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
10673 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
10674 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
10675
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010676bool
10677 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type unsigned integer is
10678 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
10679 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
10680 presence of a flag).
10681
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010010682bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
10683 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
10684 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
10685 optionnaly truncated at the given length.
10686
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010687cpl
10688 Takes the input value of type unsigned integer, applies a twos-complement
10689 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
10690
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010010691crc32([<avalanche>])
10692 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
10693 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10694 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10695 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10696 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10697 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
10698 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
10699 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
10700 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
10701 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
10702 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
10703
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010704div(<value>)
10705 Divides the input value of type unsigned integer by <value>, and returns the
10706 result as an unsigned integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
10707 integer is returned (typically 2^32-1).
10708
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010709djb2([<avalanche>])
10710 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
10711 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10712 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10713 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10714 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10715 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
10716 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010010717 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
10718 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010719
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010720even
10721 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type unsigned integer is even
10722 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
10723
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010010724field(<index>,<delimiters>)
10725 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
10726 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
10727 list of chars.
10728
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010729hex
10730 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
10731 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
10732 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
10733 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010010734
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010735http_date([<offset>])
10736 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10737 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
10738 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
10739 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
10740 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
10741 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010742
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020010743in_table(<table>)
10744 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10745 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
10746 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
10747 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
10748 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
10749
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010750ipmask(<mask>)
10751 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
10752 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
10753 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
10754 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
10755
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020010756json([<input-code>])
10757 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
10758 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
10759 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8"" or
10760 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
10761 of errors:
10762 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
10763 bytes, ...)
10764 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
10765 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
10766
10767 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
10768 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
10769 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
10770 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
10771 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
10772 are :
10773 - "ascii" : never fails ;
10774 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
10775 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
10776 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
10777 error ;
10778 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
10779 characters corresponding to the other errors.
10780
10781 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
10782 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
10783
10784 Example:
10785 capture request header user-agent len 150
10786 capture request header Host len 15
10787 log-format {"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json]"}
10788
10789 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
10790 GET / HTTP/1.0
10791 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
10792
10793 Output log:
10794 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
10795
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010796language(<value>[,<default>])
10797 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
10798 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
10799 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
10800 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
10801 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
10802 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
10803 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
10804 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
10805 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
10806 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
10807 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
10808 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010809
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010810 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010811
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010812 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
10813 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010814
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010815 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
10816 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
10817 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
10818 use_backend spanish if es
10819 use_backend french if fr
10820 use_backend english if en
10821 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010822
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010823lower
10824 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
10825 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
10826 type. The result is of type string.
10827
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020010828ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
10829 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10830 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
10831 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
10832 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
10833 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
10834 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
10835
10836 Example :
10837
10838 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
10839 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
10840 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
10841
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010842map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10843map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10844map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10845 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
10846 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
10847 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
10848 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
10849 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
10850 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
10851 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
10852 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010853
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010854 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
10855 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
10856 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010857
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010858 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
10859 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010860
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010861 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
10862 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10863 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
10864 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020010865 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
10866 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010867 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
10868 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10869 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
10870 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10871 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
10872 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10873 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
10874 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10875 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
10876 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10877 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
10878 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10879 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
10880 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010881
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010882 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
10883 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
10884 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
10885 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
10886 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010887
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010888 Example :
10889
10890 # this is a comment and is ignored
10891 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
10892 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
10893 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
10894 | | | `---------- value
10895 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
10896 | `---------------------------- key
10897 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
10898
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010899mod(<value>)
10900 Divides the input value of type unsigned integer by <value>, and returns the
10901 remainder as an unsigned integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
10902
10903mul(<value>)
10904 Multiplies the input value of type unsigned integer by <value>, and returns
10905 the product as an unsigned integer. In case of overflow, the higher bits are
10906 lost, leading to seemingly strange values.
10907
10908neg
10909 Takes the input value of type unsigned integer, computes the opposite value,
10910 and returns the remainder as an unsigned integer. 0 is identity. This
10911 operator is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input
10912 from a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
10913
10914not
10915 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type unsigned integer is
10916 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
10917 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
10918 absence of a flag).
10919
10920odd
10921 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type unsigned integer is odd
10922 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
10923
10924or(<value>)
10925 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type unsigned
10926 integer, and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
10927
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010010928regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010010929 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
10930 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
10931 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
10932 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
10933 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
10934 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
10935 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
10936 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
10937 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
10938 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
10939 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis or comma
10940 are not possible to use in the arguments. The first use of this converter is
10941 to replace certain characters or sequence of characters with other ones.
10942
10943 Example :
10944
10945 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
10946 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
10947 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
10948 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
10949
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020010950capture-req(<id>)
10951 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
10952 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
10953
10954 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
10955 "http-response capture", "req.hdr.capture" and
10956 "res.hdr.capture" (sample fetches).
10957
10958capture-res(<id>)
10959 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
10960 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
10961
10962 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
10963 "http-response capture", "req.hdr.capture" and
10964 "res.hdr.capture" (sample fetches).
10965
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010966sdbm([<avalanche>])
10967 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
10968 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10969 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10970 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10971 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10972 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
10973 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010010974 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
10975 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010976
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010977sub(<value>)
10978 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type unsigned integer, and returns
10979 the result as an unsigned integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
10980 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
10981
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020010982table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
10983 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10984 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10985 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
10986 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
10987 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
10988 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
10989
10990
10991table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
10992 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10993 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10994 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
10995 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
10996 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
10997 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
10998
10999table_conn_cnt(<table>)
11000 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11001 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11002 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
11003 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
11004 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
11005
11006table_conn_cur(<table>)
11007 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11008 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11009 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
11010 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
11011 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
11012
11013table_conn_rate(<table>)
11014 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11015 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11016 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
11017 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
11018 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
11019
11020table_gpc0(<table>)
11021 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11022 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11023 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
11024 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
11025 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
11026
11027table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
11028 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11029 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11030 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
11031 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
11032 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
11033 sample fetch keyword.
11034
11035table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
11036 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11037 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11038 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
11039 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
11040 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
11041
11042table_http_err_rate(<table>)
11043 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11044 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11045 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
11046 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
11047 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
11048 keyword.
11049
11050table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
11051 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11052 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11053 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
11054 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
11055 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
11056
11057table_http_req_rate(<table>)
11058 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11059 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11060 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
11061 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
11062 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
11063 keyword.
11064
11065table_kbytes_in(<table>)
11066 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11067 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11068 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
11069 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
11070 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
11071 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
11072 keyword.
11073
11074table_kbytes_out(<table>)
11075 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11076 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11077 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
11078 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
11079 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
11080 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
11081 keyword.
11082
11083table_server_id(<table>)
11084 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11085 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11086 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
11087 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
11088 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
11089 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
11090
11091table_sess_cnt(<table>)
11092 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11093 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11094 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
11095 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
11096 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
11097 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
11098 keyword.
11099
11100table_sess_rate(<table>)
11101 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11102 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11103 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
11104 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
11105 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
11106 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
11107 keyword.
11108
11109table_trackers(<table>)
11110 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11111 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11112 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
11113 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
11114 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
11115 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
11116 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
11117 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
11118 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
11119 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
11120
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020011121upper
11122 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
11123 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
11124 type. The result is of type string.
11125
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020011126url_dec
11127 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
11128 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
11129
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020011130utime(<format>[,<offset>])
11131 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
11132 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
11133 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
11134 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
11135 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
11136 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
11137
11138 Example :
11139
11140 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
11141 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
11142 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
11143
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010011144word(<index>,<delimiters>)
11145 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
11146 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
11147
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011148wt6([<avalanche>])
11149 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
11150 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11151 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11152 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11153 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11154 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
11155 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011156 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
11157 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011158
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011159xor(<value>)
11160 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
11161 of type unsigned integer, and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
11162
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011163
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200111647.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011165--------------------------------------------
11166
11167A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
11168not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
11169"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
11170The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
11171
11172always_false : boolean
11173 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
11174 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
11175
11176always_true : boolean
11177 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
11178 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
11179
11180avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011181 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011182 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
11183 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
11184 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
11185 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
11186 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
11187 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
11188 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
11189 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
11190 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
11191 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
11192 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
11193 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
11194 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010011195
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011196be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011197 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
11198 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
11199 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
11200 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
11201 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011202
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011203be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
11204 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
11205 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
11206 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
11207 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
11208 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
11209 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011210
11211 Example :
11212 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
11213 backend dynamic
11214 mode http
11215 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
11216 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011217
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011218connslots([<backend>]) : integer
11219 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011220 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011221 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
11222 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050011223
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011224 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011225 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011226 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
11227
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011228 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
11229 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011230
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011231 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011232 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011233 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011234 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
11235 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011236 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011237 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011238
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011239 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
11240 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011241 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011242 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011243
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020011244date([<offset>]) : integer
11245 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
11246 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
11247 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
11248 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020011249 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
11250
11251 Example :
11252
11253 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
11254 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020011255
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020011256env(<name>) : string
11257 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
11258 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
11259 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
11260 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
11261 certain way.
11262
11263 Examples :
11264 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
11265 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
11266
11267 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
11268 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
11269
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011270fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
11271 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011272 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
11273 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011274 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
11275 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
11276 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
11277 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
11278 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011279
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011280fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
11281 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
11282 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
11283 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
11284 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
11285 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
11286 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
11287 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
11288 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010011289
11290 Example :
11291 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
11292 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
11293 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
11294 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
11295 frontend mail
11296 bind :25
11297 mode tcp
11298 maxconn 100
11299 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
11300 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
11301 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
11302 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011303
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010011304nbproc : integer
11305 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
11306 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
11307 and debugging purposes.
11308
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011309nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
11310 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
11311 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
11312 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011313 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
11314 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
11315 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010011316
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010011317proc : integer
11318 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
11319 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
11320 debugging purposes.
11321
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011322queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011323 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
11324 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
11325 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011326 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
11327 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
11328 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
11329 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
11330 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
11331
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010011332rand([<range>]) : integer
11333 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
11334 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
11335 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
11336 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
11337 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
11338
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011339srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
11340 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
11341 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
11342 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
11343 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
11344 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
11345 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
11346 methods.
11347
11348srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
11349 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
11350 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
11351 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
11352 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
11353 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
11354 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
11355 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
11356
11357srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
11358 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
11359 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011360 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011361 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
11362 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
11363 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
11364 overloading servers).
11365
11366 Example :
11367 # Redirect to a separate back
11368 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
11369 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
11370 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
11371
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010011372stopping : boolean
11373 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
11374 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
11375 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
11376
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011377table_avl([<table>]) : integer
11378 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
11379 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
11380
11381table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11382 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
11383 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
11384 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
11385
11386
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200113877.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011388----------------------------------
11389
11390The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
11391closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
11392methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
11393sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
11394TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011395the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
11396counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
11397"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011398argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
11399the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
11400this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011401
11402be_id : integer
11403 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
11404 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
11405
11406dst : ip
11407 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
11408 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
11409 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
11410 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
11411 RFC 4291.
11412
11413dst_conn : integer
11414 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
11415 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
11416 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
11417 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
11418 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
11419 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
11420 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
11421 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011423dst_port : integer
11424 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
11425 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
11426 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
11427 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
11428 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
11429 an HTTP header.
11430
11431fe_id : integer
11432 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
11433 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
11434 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
11435
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011436sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011437sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
11438sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
11439sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011440 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
11441 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
11442 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
11443
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011444sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011445sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
11446sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
11447sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011448 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
11449 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
11450 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
11451
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011452sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011453sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11454sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11455sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011456 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
11457 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011458 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
11459 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
11460 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011461
11462 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
11463 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011464 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
11465 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
11466 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011467 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
11468 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
11469
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011470sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011471sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11472sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11473sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011474 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
11475 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
11476
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011477sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011478sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
11479sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
11480sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011481 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
11482 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
11483 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
11484
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011485sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011486sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
11487sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
11488sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011489 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
11490 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
11491 See also src_conn_rate.
11492
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011493sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011494sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11495sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11496sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011497 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011498 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011499
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011500sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011501sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
11502sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
11503sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011504 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11505 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
11506 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011507 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
11508 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
11509 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011510
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011511sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011512sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11513sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11514sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011515 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
11516 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
11517 See also src_http_err_cnt.
11518
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011519sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011520sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
11521sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
11522sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011523 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
11524 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
11525 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
11526 src_http_err_rate.
11527
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011528sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011529sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11530sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11531sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011532 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
11533 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
11534 src_http_req_cnt.
11535
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011536sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011537sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
11538sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
11539sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011540 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
11541 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
11542 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
11543 src_http_req_rate.
11544
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011545sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011546sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11547sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11548sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011549 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011550 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
11551 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
11552 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
11553 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011554
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011555 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
11556 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011557 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
11558
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011559sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011560sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
11561sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
11562sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011563 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
11564 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
11565 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011566
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011567sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011568sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
11569sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
11570sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011571 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
11572 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
11573 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011574
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011575sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011576sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11577sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11578sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011579 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
11580 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
11581 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
11582 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011583 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011584 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
11585
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011586sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011587sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
11588sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
11589sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011590 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
11591 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
11592 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
11593 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
11594 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011595 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011596
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011597sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011598sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
11599sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
11600sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020011601 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
11602 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
11603 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
11604
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011605sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011606sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
11607sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
11608sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010011609 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
11610 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011611 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010011612 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
11613 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011614 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
11615 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
11616 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010011617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011618so_id : integer
11619 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
11620 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
11621 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011623src : ip
11624 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
11625 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
11626 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
11627 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
11628 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
11629 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
11630 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011631
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011632 Example:
11633 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
11634 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
11635
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011636src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
11637 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
11638 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
11639 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011640 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011641
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011642src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
11643 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
11644 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011645 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011646 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011648src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11649 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
11650 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
11651 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
11652 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
11653 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
11654 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011655
11656 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
11657 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
11658 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
11659 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011660 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011661 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
11662 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
11663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011664src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011665 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011666 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011667 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011668 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011670src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011671 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011672 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
11673 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011674 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011675
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011676src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
11677 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
11678 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11679 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011680 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011681
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011682src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011683 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011684 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011685 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011686 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011687
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011688src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011689 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011690 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011691 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
11692 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011693 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
11694 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
11695 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011696
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011697src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11698 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
11699 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011700 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011701 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011702 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011703
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011704src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
11705 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
11706 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11707 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
11708 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011709 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011710
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011711src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11712 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
11713 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
11714 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011715 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011717src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
11718 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
11719 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
11720 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011721 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011722 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011724src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11725 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
11726 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
11727 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011728 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011729 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
11730 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011731
11732 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011733 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011734 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011736src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011737 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
11738 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
11739 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
11740 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
11741 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011743src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011744 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
11745 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11746 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
11747 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
11748 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020011749
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011750src_port : integer
11751 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
11752 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
11753 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
11754 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010011755
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011756src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11757 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011758 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
11759 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
11760 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011761 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011763src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
11764 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
11765 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11766 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
11767 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011768 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011769
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011770src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11771 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
11772 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
11773 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
11774 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
11775 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
11776 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
11777 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
11778 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020011779
11780 Example :
11781 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
11782 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
11783 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
11784 listen ssh
11785 bind :22
11786 mode tcp
11787 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011788 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011789 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020011790 server local 127.0.0.1:22
11791
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011792srv_id : integer
11793 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
11794 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
11795 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020011796
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010011797
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200117987.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011799----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020011800
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011801The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
11802closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
11803when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
11804usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011805future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020011806
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020011807ssl_bc : boolean
11808 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
11809 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
11810 other a server with the "ssl" option.
11811
11812ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
11813 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
11814 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11815
11816ssl_bc_cipher : string
11817 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
11818 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11819
11820ssl_bc_protocol : string
11821 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
11822 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11823
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011824ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020011825 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011826 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
11827 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020011828
11829ssl_bc_session_id : binary
11830 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
11831 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
11832 if session was reused or not.
11833
11834ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
11835 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
11836 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11837
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011838ssl_c_ca_err : integer
11839 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11840 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
11841 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
11842 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
11843 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020011844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011845ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
11846 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11847 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
11848 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
11849 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011850
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010011851ssl_c_der : binary
11852 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
11853 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11854 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
11855
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011856ssl_c_err : integer
11857 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11858 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
11859 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
11860 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
11861 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011863ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11864 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11865 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
11866 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11867 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11868 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11869 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11870 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11871 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011872
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011873ssl_c_key_alg : string
11874 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
11875 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11876 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011877
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011878ssl_c_notafter : string
11879 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
11880 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11881 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020011882
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011883ssl_c_notbefore : string
11884 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
11885 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11886 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010011887
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011888ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11889 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11890 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
11891 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11892 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11893 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11894 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11895 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11896 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010011897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011898ssl_c_serial : binary
11899 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
11900 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11901 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011903ssl_c_sha1 : binary
11904 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
11905 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
11906 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020011907 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
11908 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
11909
11910 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011911
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011912ssl_c_sig_alg : string
11913 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
11914 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
11915 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011916
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011917ssl_c_used : boolean
11918 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
11919 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020011920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011921ssl_c_verify : integer
11922 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
11923 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
11924 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
11925 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020011926
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011927ssl_c_version : integer
11928 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
11929 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020011930
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010011931ssl_f_der : binary
11932 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
11933 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11934 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
11935
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011936ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11937 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11938 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
11939 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11940 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011941 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011942 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11943 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11944 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011946ssl_f_key_alg : string
11947 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
11948 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
11949 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020011950
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011951ssl_f_notafter : string
11952 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
11953 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11954 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011955
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011956ssl_f_notbefore : string
11957 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
11958 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11959 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011961ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11962 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11963 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
11964 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11965 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11966 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11967 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11968 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11969 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020011970
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011971ssl_f_serial : binary
11972 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
11973 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11974 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011975
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020011976ssl_f_sha1 : binary
11977 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
11978 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
11979 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
11980
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011981ssl_f_sig_alg : string
11982 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
11983 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
11984 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020011985
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011986ssl_f_version : integer
11987 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
11988 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11989
11990ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011991 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
11992 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
11993 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
11994
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011995 Example :
11996 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
11997 listen http-https
11998 bind :80
11999 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
12000 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
12001
12002ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
12003 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
12004 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12005
12006ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012007 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012008 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
12009 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
12010 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
12011 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
12012 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
12013 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
12014 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
12015 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
12016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012017ssl_fc_cipher : string
12018 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
12019 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012020
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012021ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012022 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
12023 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010012024 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
12025 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
12026 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
12027 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012028
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012029ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
12030 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020012031 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
12032 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
12033 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
12034 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020012035
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020012036ssl_fc_is_resumed: boolean
12037 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
12038 SSL session cache or TLS tickets.
12039
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012040ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012041 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012042 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
12043 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
12044 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
12045 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
12046 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
12047 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
12048 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020012049
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012050ssl_fc_protocol : string
12051 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
12052 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020012053
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020012054ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040012055 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020012056 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
12057 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040012058
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012059ssl_fc_session_id : binary
12060 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
12061 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
12062 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
12063 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020012064
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012065ssl_fc_sni : string
12066 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
12067 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
12068 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
12069 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
12070 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
12071
12072 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
12073 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
12074 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020012075 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
12076 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012077
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012078 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012079 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
12080 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020012081
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012082ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
12083 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
12084 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020012085
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020012086
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200120877.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012088------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020012089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012090Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
12091sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
12092only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
12093For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
12094be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
12095can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
12096sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
12097for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
12098content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012099
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012100payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
12101 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
12102 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
12103 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012104
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012105payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
12106 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
12107 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
12108 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012109
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012110req.len : integer
12111req_len : integer (deprecated)
12112 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
12113 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
12114 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
12115 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
12116 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
12117 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
12118 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
12119 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012120
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012121req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
12122 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020012123 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
12124 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
12125 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
12126 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012127
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012128 ACL alternatives :
12129 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012130
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012131req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
12132 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
12133 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
12134 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
12135 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012136
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012137 ACL alternatives :
12138 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012139
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012140 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012141
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012142req.proto_http : boolean
12143req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
12144 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
12145 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
12146 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
12147 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
12148 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
12149 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
12150 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012151
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012152 Example:
12153 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12154 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
12155 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012156 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012157
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012158req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
12159rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12160 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
12161 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
12162 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
12163 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
12164 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
12165 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
12166 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012168 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
12169 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
12170 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
12171 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
12172 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
12173 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012174
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012175 ACL derivatives :
12176 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012177
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012178 Example :
12179 listen tse-farm
12180 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
12181 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
12182 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12183 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
12184 # apply RDP cookie persistence
12185 persist rdp-cookie
12186 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
12187 # This is only useful makes sense if
12188 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
12189 stick-table type string size 204800
12190 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
12191 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
12192 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012193
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012194 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
12195 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012196
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012197req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
12198rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
12199 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
12200 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
12201 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
12202 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012203
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012204 ACL derivatives :
12205 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012206
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012207req.ssl_hello_type : integer
12208req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
12209 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
12210 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
12211 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
12212 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
12213 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
12214 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
12215 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012217req.ssl_sni : string
12218req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
12219 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
12220 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
12221 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
12222 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
12223 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
12224 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
12225 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
12226 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
12227 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
12228 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
12229 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
12230 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012231
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012232 ACL derivatives :
12233 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012234
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012235 Examples :
12236 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
12237 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12238 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
12239 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
12240 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012241
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012242res.ssl_hello_type : integer
12243rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
12244 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
12245 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
12246 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
12247 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
12248 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
12249 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
12250 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020012251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012252req.ssl_ver : integer
12253req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
12254 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
12255 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
12256 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
12257 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
12258 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
12259 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
12260 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
12261 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
12262 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012263
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012264 ACL derivatives :
12265 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012266
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020012267res.len : integer
12268 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
12269 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
12270 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
12271 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
12272 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
12273 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
12274 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
12275 content inspection.
12276
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012277res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
12278 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020012279 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
12280 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
12281 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
12282 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012283
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012284res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
12285 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
12286 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
12287 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
12288 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012290 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012291
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012292wait_end : boolean
12293 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
12294 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
12295 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
12296 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
12297 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
12298 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
12299 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
12300 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012301
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012302 Examples :
12303 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
12304 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
12305 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012306
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012307 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
12308 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
12309 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
12310 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
12311 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
12312 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
12313 tcp-request content reject
12314
12315
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200123167.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012317--------------------------------------
12318
12319It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
12320This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
12321data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
12322its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
12323HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
12324content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
12325to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
12326more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
12327response are indexed.
12328
12329base : string
12330 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
12331 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
12332 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
12333 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
12334 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
12335 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
12336 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
12337 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
12338
12339 ACL derivatives :
12340 base : exact string match
12341 base_beg : prefix match
12342 base_dir : subdir match
12343 base_dom : domain match
12344 base_end : suffix match
12345 base_len : length match
12346 base_reg : regex match
12347 base_sub : substring match
12348
12349base32 : integer
12350 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
12351 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
12352 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012353 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
12354 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
12355 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012356
12357base32+src : binary
12358 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
12359 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
12360 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
12361 per-URL counters.
12362
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010012363capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
12364 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
12365 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
12366 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
12367
12368capture.req.method : string
12369 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
12370 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
12371 because it's allocated.
12372
12373capture.req.uri : string
12374 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
12375 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
12376 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
12377 allocated.
12378
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020012379capture.req.ver : string
12380 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
12381 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
12382 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
12383
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010012384capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
12385 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
12386 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
12387 The first entry is an index of 0.
12388 See also: "capture response header"
12389
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020012390capture.res.ver : string
12391 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
12392 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
12393 persistent flag.
12394
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020012395req.body : binary
12396 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
12397 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
12398 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
12399 the first chunk is analyzed.
12400
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020012401req.body_param([<name>) : string
12402 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
12403 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
12404 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
12405 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
12406 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
12407 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
12408 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
12409 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
12410 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
12411 given.
12412
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020012413req.body_len : integer
12414 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
12415 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
12416 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
12417 "option http-buffer-request".
12418
12419req.body_size : integer
12420 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
12421 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
12422 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
12423 that the request body has been buffered made available using
12424 "option http-buffer-request".
12425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012426req.cook([<name>]) : string
12427cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12428 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
12429 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
12430 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
12431 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
12432 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
12433 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
12434 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
12435 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
12436
12437 ACL derivatives :
12438 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
12439 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
12440 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
12441 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
12442 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
12443 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
12444 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
12445 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012446
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012447req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12448cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12449 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
12450 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012451
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012452req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
12453cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12454 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
12455 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
12456 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
12457 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020012458
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012459cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12460 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
12461 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
12462 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
12463 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
12464 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
12465 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
12466 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
12467 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
12468 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
12469 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012470
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012471hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12472 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
12473 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
12474 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
12475 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012476 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012477
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012478req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
12479 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
12480 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
12481 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
12482 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
12483 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
12484 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
12485 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
12486 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012488req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12489 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
12490 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
12491 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
12492 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012493
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012494req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12495 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
12496 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
12497 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
12498 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
12499 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
12500 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
12501 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
12502 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
12503 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
12504 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
12505 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012506
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012507 ACL derivatives :
12508 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
12509 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
12510 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
12511 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
12512 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
12513 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
12514 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
12515 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
12516
12517req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12518hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
12519 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
12520 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
12521 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
12522 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
12523 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
12524 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
12525 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
12526 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
12527 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
12528
12529req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
12530hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
12531 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
12532 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
12533 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
12534 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
12535 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
12536 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
12537 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
12538 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
12539
12540req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
12541hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
12542 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
12543 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
12544 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
12545 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
12546 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
12547 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
12548 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
12549
12550http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
12551 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
12552 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
12553 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
12554 basic auth is supported.
12555
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010012556http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
12557 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
12558 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
12559 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
12560 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012561 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
12562 basic auth is supported.
12563
12564 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010012565 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
12566 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
12567 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
12568 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012569
12570http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020012571 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
12572 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012573 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
12574 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020012575
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012576method : integer + string
12577 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
12578 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
12579 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
12580 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
12581 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
12582 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
12583 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012584
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012585 ACL derivatives :
12586 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012587
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012588 Example :
12589 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
12590 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
12591 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012593path : string
12594 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
12595 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
12596 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
12597 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
12598 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
12599 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
12600 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012601
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012602 ACL derivatives :
12603 path : exact string match
12604 path_beg : prefix match
12605 path_dir : subdir match
12606 path_dom : domain match
12607 path_end : suffix match
12608 path_len : length match
12609 path_reg : regex match
12610 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012611
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010012612query : string
12613 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
12614 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
12615 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
12616 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
12617 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the completemnt of "path"
12618 which stops before the question mark.
12619
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010012620req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
12621 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
12622 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
12623 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
12624 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
12625
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012626req.ver : string
12627req_ver : string (deprecated)
12628 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
12629 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
12630 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012631
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012632 ACL derivatives :
12633 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020012634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012635res.comp : boolean
12636 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
12637 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
12638 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012639
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012640res.comp_algo : string
12641 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
12642 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
12643 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012645res.cook([<name>]) : string
12646scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12647 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
12648 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
12649 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020012650
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012651 ACL derivatives :
12652 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020012653
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012654res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12655scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12656 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
12657 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
12658 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012659
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012660res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
12661scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12662 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
12663 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
12664 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012666res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12667 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
12668 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
12669 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
12670 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
12671 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
12672 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
12673 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
12674 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
12675 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012677res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12678 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
12679 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
12680 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
12681 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
12682 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012683
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012684res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12685shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
12686 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
12687 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
12688 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
12689 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
12690 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
12691 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
12692 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
12693 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012694
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012695 ACL derivatives :
12696 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
12697 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
12698 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
12699 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
12700 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
12701 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
12702 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
12703 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
12704
12705res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12706shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12707 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
12708 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
12709 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
12710 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
12711 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012712
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012713res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
12714shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
12715 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
12716 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
12717 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
12718 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
12719 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
12720 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012721
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010012722res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
12723 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
12724 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
12725 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
12726 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
12727
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012728res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
12729shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
12730 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
12731 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
12732 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
12733 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
12734 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
12735 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010012736
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012737res.ver : string
12738resp_ver : string (deprecated)
12739 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
12740 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020012741
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012742 ACL derivatives :
12743 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010012744
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012745set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12746 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
12747 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
12748 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
12749 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010012750
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012751 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
12752 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010012753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012754 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012755
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012756status : integer
12757 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
12758 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
12759 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012760
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012761url : string
12762 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
12763 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
12764 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
12765 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
12766 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
12767 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
12768 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012769
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012770 ACL derivatives :
12771 url : exact string match
12772 url_beg : prefix match
12773 url_dir : subdir match
12774 url_dom : domain match
12775 url_end : suffix match
12776 url_len : length match
12777 url_reg : regex match
12778 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012780url_ip : ip
12781 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
12782 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
12783 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
12784 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
12785 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
12786 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
12787 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012788
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012789url_port : integer
12790 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
12791 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
12792 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
12793 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012794
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020012795urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
12796url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012797 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
12798 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020012799 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
12800 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
12801 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
12802 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012803 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
12804 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020012805 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
12806 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012808 ACL derivatives :
12809 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
12810 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
12811 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
12812 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
12813 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
12814 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
12815 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
12816 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012817
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012818
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012819 Example :
12820 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
12821 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
12822 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
12823 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012824
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020012825urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>])] : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012826 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
12827 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
12828 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020012829
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010012830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200128317.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012832---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010012833
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012834Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
12835every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012836order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010012837
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012838ACL name Equivalent to Usage
12839---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012840FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020012841HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012842HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
12843HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012844HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
12845HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
12846HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
12847HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
12848LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012849METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
12850METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
12851METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
12852METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
12853METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
12854METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020012855RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012856REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012857TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012858WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
12859---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010012860
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012861
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128628. Logging
12863----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012864
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012865One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
12866provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
12867very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
12868provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
12869state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012870to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012871headers.
12872
12873In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
12874about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
12875send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
12876
12877 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
12878 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
12879 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
12880 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
12881 at the termination.
12882
12883The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
12884allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
12885as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
12886while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
12887real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
12888delay.
12889
12890
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128918.1. Log levels
12892---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012893
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090012894TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012895source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090012896HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
12897in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
12898track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
12899syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
12900about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012901
12902
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129038.2. Log formats
12904----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012905
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012906HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090012907and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
12908slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
12909options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012910
12911 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
12912 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
12913 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
12914 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
12915 extents.
12916
12917 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
12918 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
12919 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
12920 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
12921 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
12922
12923 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
12924 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
12925 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
12926 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
12927 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
12928
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020012929 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
12930 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
12931 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
12932 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
12933
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012934 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
12935
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012936Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
12937specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
12938field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
12939servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
12940always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
12941identifier.
12942
12943Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
12944 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
12945 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
12946 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
12947 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
12948
12949
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129508.2.1. Default log format
12951-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012952
12953This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
12954as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
12955format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
12956
12957 Example :
12958 listen www
12959 mode http
12960 log global
12961 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12962
12963 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
12964 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
12965 (www/HTTP)
12966
12967 Field Format Extract from the example above
12968 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
12969 2 'Connect from' Connect from
12970 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
12971 4 'to' to
12972 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
12973 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
12974
12975Detailed fields description :
12976 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
12977 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
12978 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
12979 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
12980 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12981 and processed the connection.
12982 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
12983
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012984In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
12985"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
12986connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
12987
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012988It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
12989will eventually disappear.
12990
12991
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129928.2.2. TCP log format
12993---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012994
12995The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
12996is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
12997information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
12998counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
12999emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
13000environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
13001the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
13002sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020013003specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
13004not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
13005fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
13006marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013007
13008 Example :
13009 frontend fnt
13010 mode tcp
13011 option tcplog
13012 log global
13013 default_backend bck
13014
13015 backend bck
13016 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
13017
13018 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
13019 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
13020 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
13021
13022 Field Format Extract from the example above
13023 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
13024 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
13025 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
13026 4 frontend_name fnt
13027 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
13028 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
13029 7 bytes_read* 212
13030 8 termination_state --
13031 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
13032 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
13033
13034Detailed fields description :
13035 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013036 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
13037 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
13038 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
13039 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
13040 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013041
13042 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013043 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
13044 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
13045 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013046
13047 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
13048 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
13049 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
13050 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
13051
13052 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
13053 and processed the connection.
13054
13055 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
13056 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
13057 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
13058 applications.
13059
13060 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
13061 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
13062 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
13063 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
13064 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
13065
13066 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
13067 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
13068 See "Timers" below for more details.
13069
13070 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
13071 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
13072 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
13073 "Timers" below for more details.
13074
13075 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013076 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013077 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
13078 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
13079 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
13080 details.
13081
13082 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
13083 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
13084 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
13085 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
13086 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
13087
13088 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
13089 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
13090 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
13091 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
13092 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
13093 for more details.
13094
13095 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013096 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013097 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
13098 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
13099 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013100 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013101
13102 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
13103 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
13104 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
13105 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
13106 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
13107 caused by a denial of service attack.
13108
13109 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
13110 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
13111 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
13112 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
13113 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
13114 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
13115 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
13116 denial of service attack.
13117
13118 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
13119 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
13120 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
13121 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
13122 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
13123 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
13124 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
13125 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
13126 be processed than on other servers.
13127
13128 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
13129 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
13130 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
13131 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
13132 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
13133 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
13134 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
13135 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
13136 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
13137 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
13138 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
13139 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
13140 should not be attributed to the logged server.
13141
13142 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
13143 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
13144 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
13145 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
13146 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
13147 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
13148 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
13149 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
13150
13151 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
13152 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
13153 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
13154 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
13155 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
13156 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
13157 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
13158 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
13159 occurs.
13160
13161
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200131628.2.3. HTTP log format
13163----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013164
13165The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
13166is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
13167the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
13168are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
13169emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
13170generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
13171"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
13172which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020013173frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
13174is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013175
13176Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
13177slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
13178with a star ('*') after the field name below.
13179
13180 Example :
13181 frontend http-in
13182 mode http
13183 option httplog
13184 log global
13185 default_backend bck
13186
13187 backend static
13188 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
13189
13190 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
13191 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
13192 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013193 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013194
13195 Field Format Extract from the example above
13196 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
13197 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
13198 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
13199 4 frontend_name http-in
13200 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
13201 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
13202 7 status_code 200
13203 8 bytes_read* 2750
13204 9 captured_request_cookie -
13205 10 captured_response_cookie -
13206 11 termination_state ----
13207 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
13208 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
13209 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
13210 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
13211 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013212
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013213
13214Detailed fields description :
13215 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013216 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
13217 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
13218 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
13219 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
13220 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013221
13222 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013223 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
13224 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
13225 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013226
13227 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
13228 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
13229 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
13230 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
13231 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
13232
13233 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
13234 and processed the connection.
13235
13236 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
13237 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
13238 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
13239
13240 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
13241 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
13242 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
13243 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
13244 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
13245 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
13246
13247 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
13248 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
13249 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
13250 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
13251 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
13252 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
13253
13254 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
13255 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
13256 See "Timers" below for more details.
13257
13258 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
13259 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
13260 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
13261 below for more details.
13262
13263 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
13264 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
13265 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
13266 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
13267 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
13268 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
13269 for more details.
13270
13271 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013272 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013273 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
13274 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
13275 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
13276 details.
13277
13278 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
13279 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
13280 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
13281
13282 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
13283 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
13284 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
13285 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
13286 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
13287 overflowing.
13288
13289 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
13290 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
13291 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
13292 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
13293 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
13294 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
13295 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
13296 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
13297
13298 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
13299 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
13300 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
13301 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
13302 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
13303 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
13304 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
13305 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
13306
13307 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
13308 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
13309 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
13310 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
13311 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
13312 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
13313 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
13314
13315 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013316 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013317 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
13318 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
13319 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013320 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013321 system.
13322
13323 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
13324 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
13325 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
13326 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
13327 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
13328 caused by a denial of service attack.
13329
13330 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
13331 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
13332 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
13333 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
13334 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
13335 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
13336 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
13337 denial of service attack.
13338
13339 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
13340 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
13341 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
13342 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
13343 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
13344 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
13345 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
13346 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
13347 processed than on other servers.
13348
13349 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
13350 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
13351 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
13352 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
13353 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
13354 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
13355 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
13356 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
13357 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
13358 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
13359 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
13360 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
13361 should not be attributed to the logged server.
13362
13363 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
13364 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
13365 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
13366 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
13367 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
13368 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
13369 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
13370 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
13371
13372 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
13373 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
13374 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
13375 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
13376 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
13377 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
13378 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
13379 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
13380 occurs.
13381
13382 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
13383 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
13384 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
13385 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
13386 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
13387 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
13388 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
13389 cookies" below for more details.
13390
13391 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
13392 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
13393 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
13394 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
13395 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
13396 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
13397 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
13398 and cookies" below for more details.
13399
13400 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
13401 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
13402 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
13403 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
13404 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
13405 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
13406 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
13407 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
13408
13409
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200134108.2.4. Custom log format
13411------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013412
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013413The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013414mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013415
13416HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
13417Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
13418separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
13419prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
13420
13421Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
13422variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
13423string formats ("Q").
13424
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010013425If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020013426as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010013427less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
13428the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
13429
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013430Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013431In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010013432in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013433
13434Flags are :
13435 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013436 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013437
13438 Example:
13439
13440 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
13441 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
13442
13443At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
13444
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013445 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
13446 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013447
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013448the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013449
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013450 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020013451 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013452 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013453
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013454and the default TCP format is defined this way :
13455
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013456 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013457 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
13458
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013459Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
13460
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013461 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013462 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013463 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
13464 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
13465 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013466 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
13467 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
13468 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013469 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000013470 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
13471 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
13472 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
13473 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013474 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020013475 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013476 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013477 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080013478 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013479 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
13480 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013481 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013482 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
13483 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013484 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013485 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
13486 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013487 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
13488 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
13489 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013490 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013491 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
13492 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013493 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013494 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
13495 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
13496 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020013497 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020013498 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020013499 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
13500 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
13501 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
13502 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013503 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013504 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013505 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013506 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010013507 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013508 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013509 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
13510 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
13511 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013512 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013513 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
13514 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013515 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013516 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013517 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013518 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013519
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013520 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013521
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010013522
135238.2.5. Error log format
13524-----------------------
13525
13526When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
13527protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
13528By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
13529"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
13530will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
13531logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
13532
13533The format looks like this :
13534
13535 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
13536 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
13537 Connection error during SSL handshake
13538
13539 Field Format Extract from the example above
13540 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
13541 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
13542 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
13543 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
13544 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
13545
13546These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
13547failures.
13548
13549
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135508.3. Advanced logging options
13551-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013552
13553Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
13554just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
13555options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
13556for more information about their usage.
13557
13558
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135598.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
13560------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013561
13562It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
13563haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
13564commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
13565monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
13566ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
13567
13568 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
13569 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
13570 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
13571 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
13572
13573 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
13574 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
13575 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013576 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013577 such as other load-balancers.
13578
13579 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
13580 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
13581 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
13582
13583
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135848.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
13585----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013586
13587The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
13588what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
13589or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
13590"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
13591just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
13592log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
13593after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
13594is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
13595with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
13596with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
13597
13598
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135998.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
13600------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020013601
13602Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
13603for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
13604"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
13605retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
13606raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
13607a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
13608file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
13609you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
13610"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
13611
13612
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136138.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
13614--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020013615
13616Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
13617multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
13618them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
13619"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
13620logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
13621error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
13622and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
13623too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
13624useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
13625alternative.
13626
13627
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136288.4. Timing events
13629------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013630
13631Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
13632reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
13633the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
13634frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
13635mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
13636
13637 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
13638 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
13639 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
13640 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
13641 the client closes prematurely or times out.
13642
13643 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
13644 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
13645 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
13646 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
13647 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
13648
13649 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
13650 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
13651 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
13652 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
13653 connection never established.
13654
13655 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
13656 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
13657 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
13658 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
13659 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
13660 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
13661 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
13662 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
13663 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
13664 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
13665 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
13666
13667 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
13668 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
13669 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
13670 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013671 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013672
13673 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
13674
13675 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
13676 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
13677 negative.
13678
13679These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
13680protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
13681that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013682due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013683close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
13684session has been aborted on timeout.
13685
13686Most common cases :
13687
13688 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
13689 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
13690 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
13691 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
13692 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
13693 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
13694 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
13695 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
13696 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020013697 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
13698 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
13699 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013700
13701 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
13702 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
13703 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
13704 of ms on remote networks.
13705
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013706 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
13707 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
13708 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013709
13710 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
13711 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
13712 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
13713 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
13714 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
13715 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
13716 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
13717 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
13718 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
13719 to the server until another one is released.
13720
13721Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
13722
13723 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
13724 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
13725 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
13726
13727 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
13728 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
13729 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
13730
13731 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
13732 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
13733 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
13734 flags.
13735
13736 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
13737 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
13738 Check the session termination flags, then check the
13739 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
13740 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
13741 the client connection was maintained open.
13742
13743 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013744 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013745 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
13746 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
13747
13748
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137498.5. Session state at disconnection
13750-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013751
13752TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
13753"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
137542-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
13755each of which has a special meaning :
13756
13757 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
13758 session to terminate :
13759
13760 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
13761
13762 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
13763 server explicitly refused it.
13764
13765 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
13766 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
13767 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
13768 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020013769 (eg: cacheable cookie).
13770
13771 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
13772 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013773
13774 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
13775 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
13776 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
13777 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
13778 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
13779
13780 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
13781 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
13782 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
13783 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
13784 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
13785
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090013786 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
13787 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
13788
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013789 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
13790 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
13791 backup connections when going up.
13792
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020013793 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
13794
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013795 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
13796 send or receive data.
13797
13798 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
13799 send or receive data.
13800
13801 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
13802 with nothing left in the buffers.
13803
13804 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
13805
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010013806 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013807 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
13808
13809 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
13810 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
13811 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
13812 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
13813 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
13814
13815 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
13816 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
13817
13818 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
13819 server (HTTP only).
13820
13821 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
13822
13823 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
13824 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
13825 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
13826
13827 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
13828 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
13829 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
13830
13831 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
13832
13833 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
13834 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
13835
13836 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
13837 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
13838 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
13839
13840 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
13841 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020013842 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
13843 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013844
13845 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
13846 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
13847 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
13848 another server.
13849
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013850 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013851 server.
13852
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013853 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
13854 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
13855 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
13856 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
13857
13858 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
13859 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
13860 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
13861 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
13862
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020013863 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
13864 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
13865 "use-server" rule).
13866
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013867 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
13868
13869 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
13870 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
13871
13872 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
13873
13874 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
13875 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
13876 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
13877
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013878 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
13879 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013880 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013881 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
13882 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
13883
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013884 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
13885
13886 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
13887 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
13888
13889 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
13890
13891 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
13892
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013893The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
13894was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013895helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
13896starvation, attacks, etc...
13897
13898The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
13899alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
13900easier finding and understanding.
13901
13902 Flags Reason
13903
13904 -- Normal termination.
13905
13906 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
13907 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
13908 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
13909 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
13910
13911 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
13912 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
13913 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
13914 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
13915 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
13916 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013917
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013918 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
13919 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020013920 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013921
13922 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
13923 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
13924 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
13925
13926 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
13927 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
13928 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
13929 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
13930 the server takes too long to respond.
13931
13932 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
13933 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
13934 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
13935 long a time to respond.
13936
13937 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
13938 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
13939 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
13940 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013941 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
13942 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013943
13944 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
13945 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
13946 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
13947 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
13948 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020013949 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013950 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
13951 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
13952 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
13953 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
13954 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
13955 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
13956 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
13957 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
13958 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
13959 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
13960 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
13961 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013962
13963 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
13964 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013965 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
13966 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
13967 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
13968 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013969
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020013970 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
13971 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
13972
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013973 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013974 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
13975 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
13976 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
13977 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
13978 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
13979
13980 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
13981 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
13982 503 or 504 here.
13983
13984 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
13985 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
13986 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
13987 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
13988 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
13989
13990 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
13991 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013992 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013993 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
13994 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
13995
13996 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
13997 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
13998 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
13999 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
14000 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
14001 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
14002 between haproxy and the server.
14003
14004 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
14005 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
14006 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
14007 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
14008 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
14009 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
14010 solution is to fix the application.
14011
14012 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
14013 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
14014 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
14015 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
14016 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
14017 external attacks.
14018
14019 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
14020 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020014021 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014022 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
14023 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
14024
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010014025 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
14026 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
14027 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020014028 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
14029 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010014030
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014031 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
14032 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
14033 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
14034 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010014035 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
14036 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
14037 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
14038 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
14039 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014040
14041 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
14042 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
14043 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
14044 returned an HTTP 403 error.
14045
14046 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
14047 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
14048 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
14049 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
14050
14051 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
14052 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
14053 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
14054 only be solved by proper system tuning.
14055
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014056The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
14057persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
14058important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
14059re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
14060
14061 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
14062
14063 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
14064 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
14065 set on a GET request.
14066
14067 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
14068 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014069 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014070 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
14071
14072 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
14073 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
14074 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
14075
14076 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
14077 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
14078 already got a cookie.
14079
14080 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
14081 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
14082 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
14083 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
14084 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
14085
14086 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
14087 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
14088 new cookie was inserted in the response.
14089
14090 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
14091 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
14092 new cookie was inserted in the response.
14093
14094 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
14095 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
14096
14097 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
14098 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
14099 then advertised in the response.
14100
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014101
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141028.6. Non-printable characters
14103-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014104
14105In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
14106consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
14107converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
14108prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
14109being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
14110escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
14111is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
14112'}' when logging headers.
14113
14114Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
14115issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
14116containing spaces is "User-Agent".
14117
14118Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
14119the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
14120performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
14121
14122
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141238.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
14124---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014125
14126Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
14127achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014128section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014129cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
14130the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
14131the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014132locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014133not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
14134user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
14135a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
14136wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
14137
14138 Examples :
14139 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
14140 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
14141
14142 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
14143 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
14144
14145
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141468.8. Capturing HTTP headers
14147---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014148
14149Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
14150proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
14151the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
14152server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
14153
14154Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
14155response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014156section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014157
14158It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014159time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
14160appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014161are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
14162and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
14163follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
14164request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
14165in the logs.
14166
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020014167As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
14168frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
14169an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
14170
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014171 Example :
14172 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
14173 listen proxy-out
14174 mode http
14175 option httplog
14176 option logasap
14177 log global
14178 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
14179
14180 # log the name of the virtual server
14181 capture request header Host len 20
14182
14183 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
14184 capture request header Content-Length len 10
14185
14186 # log the beginning of the referrer
14187 capture request header Referer len 20
14188
14189 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
14190 capture response header Server len 20
14191
14192 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
14193 capture response header Content-Length len 10
14194
14195 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
14196 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
14197
14198 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
14199 capture response header Via len 20
14200
14201 # log the URL location during a redirection
14202 capture response header Location len 20
14203
14204 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
14205 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
14206 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
14207 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
14208 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
14209
14210 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
14211 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
14212 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
14213 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014214 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014215
14216 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
14217 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
14218 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
14219 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
14220 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014221 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014222
14223
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200142248.9. Examples of logs
14225---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014226
14227These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
14228them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
14229reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
14230
14231 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
14232 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
14233 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
14234
14235 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
14236 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
14237
14238 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
14239 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
14240 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
14241
14242 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
14243 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
14244
14245 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
14246 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
14247 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
14248
14249 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014250 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014251 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
14252 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
14253
14254 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
14255 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
14256 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
14257
14258 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
14259 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020014260 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014261 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
14262 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
14263 to return the 502 and not the server.
14264
14265 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014266 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014267
14268 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
14269 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
14270 Nothing was sent to any server.
14271
14272 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
14273 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
14274
14275 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
14276 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
14277 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
14278 send a 408 return code to the client.
14279
14280 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
14281 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
14282
14283 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
14284 5 seconds ("c----").
14285
14286 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
14287 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014288 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014289
14290 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014291 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014292 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
14293 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
14294 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
14295 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
14296 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014297
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014298
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200142999. Statistics and monitoring
14300----------------------------
14301
14302It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
14303mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
14304CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
14305Unix socket.
14306
14307
143089.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014309---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010014310
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010014311The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
Willy Tarreaua3310dc2014-06-16 15:43:21 +020014312page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow. The first line
14313begins with a sharp ('#') and has one word per comma-delimited field which
14314represents the title of the column. All other lines starting at the second one
14315use a classical CSV format using a comma as the delimiter, and the double quote
14316('"') as an optional text delimiter, but only if the enclosed text is ambiguous
14317(if it contains a quote or a comma). The double-quote character ('"') in the
14318text is doubled ('""'), which is the format that most tools recognize. Please
14319do not insert any column before these ones in order not to break tools which
14320use hard-coded column positions.
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010014321
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040014322In brackets after each field name are the types which may have a value for
14323that field. The types are L (Listeners), F (Frontends), B (Backends), and
14324S (Servers).
14325
14326 0. pxname [LFBS]: proxy name
14327 1. svname [LFBS]: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend,
14328 any name for server/listener)
14329 2. qcur [..BS]: current queued requests. For the backend this reports the
14330 number queued without a server assigned.
14331 3. qmax [..BS]: max value of qcur
14332 4. scur [LFBS]: current sessions
14333 5. smax [LFBS]: max sessions
14334 6. slim [LFBS]: configured session limit
14335 7. stot [LFBS]: cumulative number of connections
14336 8. bin [LFBS]: bytes in
14337 9. bout [LFBS]: bytes out
14338 10. dreq [LFB.]: requests denied because of security concerns.
14339 - For tcp this is because of a matched tcp-request content rule.
14340 - For http this is because of a matched http-request or tarpit rule.
14341 11. dresp [LFBS]: responses denied because of security concerns.
14342 - For http this is because of a matched http-request rule, or
14343 "option checkcache".
14344 12. ereq [LF..]: request errors. Some of the possible causes are:
14345 - early termination from the client, before the request has been sent.
14346 - read error from the client
14347 - client timeout
14348 - client closed connection
14349 - various bad requests from the client.
14350 - request was tarpitted.
14351 13. econ [..BS]: number of requests that encountered an error trying to
14352 connect to a backend server. The backend stat is the sum of the stat
14353 for all servers of that backend, plus any connection errors not
14354 associated with a particular server (such as the backend having no
14355 active servers).
14356 14. eresp [..BS]: response errors. srv_abrt will be counted here also.
14357 Some other errors are:
14358 - write error on the client socket (won't be counted for the server stat)
14359 - failure applying filters to the response.
14360 15. wretr [..BS]: number of times a connection to a server was retried.
14361 16. wredis [..BS]: number of times a request was redispatched to another
14362 server. The server value counts the number of times that server was
14363 switched away from.
14364 17. status [LFBS]: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Pavlos Parissis1f673c72015-05-02 20:30:44 +020014365 18. weight [..BS]: total weight (backend), server weight (server)
14366 19. act [..BS]: number of active servers (backend), server is active (server)
14367 20. bck [..BS]: number of backup servers (backend), server is backup (server)
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040014368 21. chkfail [...S]: number of failed checks. (Only counts checks failed when
14369 the server is up.)
14370 22. chkdown [..BS]: number of UP->DOWN transitions. The backend counter counts
14371 transitions to the whole backend being down, rather than the sum of the
14372 counters for each server.
14373 23. lastchg [..BS]: number of seconds since the last UP<->DOWN transition
14374 24. downtime [..BS]: total downtime (in seconds). The value for the backend
14375 is the downtime for the whole backend, not the sum of the server downtime.
14376 25. qlimit [...S]: configured maxqueue for the server, or nothing in the
14377 value is 0 (default, meaning no limit)
14378 26. pid [LFBS]: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
14379 27. iid [LFBS]: unique proxy id
14380 28. sid [L..S]: server id (unique inside a proxy)
14381 29. throttle [...S]: current throttle percentage for the server, when
14382 slowstart is active, or no value if not in slowstart.
14383 30. lbtot [..BS]: total number of times a server was selected, either for new
14384 sessions, or when re-dispatching. The server counter is the number
14385 of times that server was selected.
14386 31. tracked [...S]: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled.
14387 32. type [LFBS]: (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket/listener)
14388 33. rate [.FBS]: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
14389 34. rate_lim [.F..]: configured limit on new sessions per second
14390 35. rate_max [.FBS]: max number of new sessions per second
14391 36. check_status [...S]: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014392 UNK -> unknown
14393 INI -> initializing
14394 SOCKERR -> socket error
14395 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
Jason Harvey83104802015-04-16 11:13:21 -080014396 L4TOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014397 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
14398 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
14399 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
14400 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
14401 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
14402 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
14403 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
14404 disable-on-404
14405 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
14406 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
14407 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040014408 37. check_code [...S]: layer5-7 code, if available
14409 38. check_duration [...S]: time in ms took to finish last health check
14410 39. hrsp_1xx [.FBS]: http responses with 1xx code
14411 40. hrsp_2xx [.FBS]: http responses with 2xx code
14412 41. hrsp_3xx [.FBS]: http responses with 3xx code
14413 42. hrsp_4xx [.FBS]: http responses with 4xx code
14414 43. hrsp_5xx [.FBS]: http responses with 5xx code
14415 44. hrsp_other [.FBS]: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
14416 45. hanafail [...S]: failed health checks details
14417 46. req_rate [.F..]: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
14418 47. req_rate_max [.F..]: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
14419 48. req_tot [.F..]: total number of HTTP requests received
14420 49. cli_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the client
14421 50. srv_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the server
14422 (inc. in eresp)
14423 51. comp_in [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
14424 52. comp_out [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
14425 53. comp_byp [.FB.]: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor
14426 (CPU/BW limit)
14427 54. comp_rsp [.FB.]: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
14428 55. lastsess [..BS]: number of seconds since last session assigned to
14429 server/backend
14430 56. last_chk [...S]: last health check contents or textual error
14431 57. last_agt [...S]: last agent check contents or textual error
14432 58. qtime [..BS]: the average queue time in ms over the 1024 last requests
14433 59. ctime [..BS]: the average connect time in ms over the 1024 last requests
14434 60. rtime [..BS]: the average response time in ms over the 1024 last requests
14435 (0 for TCP)
14436 61. ttime [..BS]: the average total session time in ms over the 1024 last
14437 requests
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014438
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014439
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200144409.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014441-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010014442
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020014443The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
14444necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
14445A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
14446issuing commands by hand :
14447
14448 global
14449 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
14450 stats timeout 2m
14451
14452It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
14453the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
14454never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
14455situations :
14456
14457 global
14458 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
14459 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
14460 stats timeout 2m
14461
14462To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
14463swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
14464to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
14465syntaxes we'll use are the following :
14466
14467 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
14468 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
14469
14470The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
14471script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
14472for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
14473
14474The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
14475that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
14476editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
14477(eg: watch a counter).
14478
14479The socket supports two operation modes :
14480 - interactive
14481 - non-interactive
14482
14483The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
14484this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
14485sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
14486mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
14487commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
14488example :
14489
14490 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
14491
14492The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
14493entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
14494for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
14495sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
14496"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
14497after processing the last command of the same line.
14498
14499For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
14500"prompt" command :
14501
14502 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
14503 prompt
14504 > show info
14505 ...
14506 >
14507
14508Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
14509delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
14510that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
14511parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014512
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014513It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
14514on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
14515own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014516
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020014517The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
14518If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
14519all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
14520it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
14521
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014522add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014523 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
14524 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
14525 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
14526 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014527
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014528add map <map> <key> <value>
14529 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
14530 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014531 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
14532 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
14533 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014534
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014535clear counters
14536 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
14537 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
14538 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
14539 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
14540 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
14541
14542clear counters all
14543 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
14544 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
14545 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
14546
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014547clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014548 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
14549 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
14550 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014551
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014552clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014553 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
14554 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
14555 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014556
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090014557clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
14558 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
14559
14560 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
14561 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
14562 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
14563 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
14564 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
14565 later after the session ends is usual enough.
14566
14567 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
14568
14569 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
14570 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
14571 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
14572 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
14573 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
14574 the ACLs :
14575
14576 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
14577 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
14578 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
14579 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
14580 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
14581 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
14582
14583 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090014584 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
14585 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014586
14587 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014588 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020014589 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014590 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
14591 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
14592 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14593 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014594
14595 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14596
14597 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020014598 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014599 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14600 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090014601 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14602 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14603 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014604
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014605del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
14606 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014607 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
14608 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
14609 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
14610 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014611
14612del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010014613 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014614 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
14615 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
14616 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
14617 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010014618
14619disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090014620 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
14621
14622 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
14623 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
14624 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
14625 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
14626 re-enabled using enable agent.
14627
14628 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
14629 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
14630 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
14631 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
14632 otherwise unchanged.
14633
14634 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
14635 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
14636 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
14637
14638 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14639 level "admin".
14640
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020014641disable frontend <frontend>
14642 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
14643 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
14644 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
14645 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
14646 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
14647 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
14648 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
14649 on the stats page.
14650
14651 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
14652 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14653
14654 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14655 level "admin".
14656
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020014657disable health <backend>/<server>
14658 Mark the primary health check as temporarily stopped. This will disable
14659 sending of health checks, and the last health check result will be ignored.
14660 The server will be in unchecked state and considered UP unless an auxiliary
14661 agent check forces it down.
14662
14663 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14664 level "admin".
14665
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014666disable server <backend>/<server>
14667 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
14668 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
14669 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
14670 during the maintenance.
14671
14672 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
14673 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
14674
14675 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020014676 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014677
14678 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14679 level "admin".
14680
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090014681enable agent <backend>/<server>
14682 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
14683
14684 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
14685 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
14686
14687 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14688 level "admin".
14689
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020014690enable frontend <frontend>
14691 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
14692 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
14693 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
14694 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
14695 which was disabled.
14696
14697 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
14698 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14699
14700 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14701 level "admin".
14702
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020014703enable health <backend>/<server>
14704 Resume a primary health check that was temporarily stopped. This will enable
14705 sending of health checks again. Please see "disable health" for details.
14706
14707 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14708 level "admin".
14709
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014710enable server <backend>/<server>
14711 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
14712 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
14713
14714 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020014715 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014716
14717 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14718 level "admin".
14719
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010014720get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014721get acl <acl> <value>
14722 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
14723 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
14724 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
14725 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
14726 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010014727
14728 The first two words are:
14729
14730 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
14731 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
14732 "dom", "end" or "reg".
14733
14734 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
14735
14736 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
14737
14738 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
14739
14740 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
14741 interpretation of the case.
14742
14743 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
14744 useful with regular expressions.
14745
14746 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
14747 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
14748
14749 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
14750 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
14751 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
14752
14753 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
14754
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014755get weight <backend>/<server>
14756 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
14757 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
14758 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
14759 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
14760 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020014761 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014762
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014763help
14764 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
14765 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014766
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014767prompt
14768 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
14769 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
14770 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
14771 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
14772 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
14773 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
14774 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
14775 command.
14776
14777quit
14778 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010014779
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014780set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014781 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
14782 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
14783 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014784
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020014785set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020014786 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
14787 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
14788 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
14789 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
14790 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020014791 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
14792 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14793
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020014794set maxconn global <maxconn>
14795 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
14796 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
14797 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
14798 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
14799 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
14800 setting.
14801
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020014802set rate-limit connections global <value>
14803 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
14804 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
14805 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
14806 is passed in number of connections per second.
14807
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010014808set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
14809 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
14810 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010014811 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
14812 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010014813
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020014814set rate-limit sessions global <value>
14815 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
14816 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
14817 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
14818 is passed in number of sessions per second.
14819
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020014820set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
14821 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
14822 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
14823 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
14824 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
14825 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
14826
Willy Tarreau2a4b70f2014-05-22 18:42:35 +020014827set server <backend>/<server> agent [ up | down ]
14828 Force a server's agent to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
14829 switch a server's state regardless of some slow agent checks for example.
14830 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
14831
14832set server <backend>/<server> health [ up | stopping | down ]
14833 Force a server's health to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
14834 switch a server's state regardless of some slow health checks for example.
14835 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
14836
14837set server <backend>/<server> state [ ready | drain | maint ]
14838 Force a server's administrative state to a new state. This can be useful to
14839 disable load balancing and/or any traffic to a server. Setting the state to
14840 "ready" puts the server in normal mode, and the command is the equivalent of
14841 the "enable server" command. Setting the state to "maint" disables any traffic
14842 to the server as well as any health checks. This is the equivalent of the
14843 "disable server" command. Setting the mode to "drain" only removes the server
14844 from load balancing but still allows it to be checked and to accept new
14845 persistent connections. Changes are propagated to tracking servers if any.
14846
14847set server <backend>/<server> weight <weight>[%]
14848 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. This is the exact
14849 equivalent of the "set weight" command below.
14850
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020014851set ssl ocsp-response <response>
14852 This command is used to update an OCSP Response for a certificate (see "crt"
14853 on "bind" lines). Same controls are performed as during the initial loading of
14854 the response. The <response> must be passed as a base64 encoded string of the
14855 DER encoded response from the OCSP server.
14856
14857 Example:
14858 openssl ocsp -issuer issuer.pem -cert server.pem \
14859 -host ocsp.issuer.com:80 -respout resp.der
14860 echo "set ssl ocsp-response $(base64 -w 10000 resp.der)" | \
14861 socat stdio /var/run/haproxy.stat
14862
Nenad Merdanovicc6985f02015-05-09 08:46:02 +020014863set ssl tls-key <id> <tlskey>
14864 Set the next TLS key for the <id> listener to <tlskey>. This key becomes the
14865 ultimate key, while the penultimate one is used for encryption (others just
14866 decrypt). The oldest TLS key present is overwritten. <id> is either a numeric
14867 #<id> or <file> returned by "show tls-keys". <tlskey> is a base64 encoded 48
14868 bit TLS ticket key (ex. openssl rand -base64 48).
14869
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020014870set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020014871 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
14872 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
14873 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
14874 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020014875 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
14876 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020014877
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014878set timeout cli <delay>
14879 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
14880 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
14881 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
14882
14883set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
14884 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
14885 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090014886 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
14887 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
14888 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
14889 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
14890 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
14891 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
14892 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
14893 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
14894 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
14895 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
14896 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
14897 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
14898 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014899
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014900show errors [<iid>]
14901 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
14902 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020014903 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
14904 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
14905 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014906
14907 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
14908 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
14909 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
14910 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
14911 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
14912 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
14913 are reported too.
14914
14915 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
14916 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
14917 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
14918 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
14919 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
14920 code.
14921
14922 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
14923 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
14924 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
14925 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
14926 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
14927 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
14928 line.
14929
14930 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014931 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14932 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014933 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
14934 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
14935
14936 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
14937 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
14938 00038 Location: blah\r\n
14939 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
14940 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
14941 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
14942 00204+ minal\r\n
14943 00211 \r\n
14944
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014945 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014946 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
14947 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
14948 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
14949 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
14950 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
14951 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010014952
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014953show info
14954 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
14955
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014956show map [<map>]
14957 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014958 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
14959 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
14960 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
14961 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
14962 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
14963 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014964
14965show acl [<acl>]
14966 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014967 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
14968 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
14969 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
14970 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
14971 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014972
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010014973show pools
14974 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
14975 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
14976 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
14977 the pools.
14978
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014979show sess
14980 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020014981 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
14982 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
14983
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010014984show sess <id>
14985 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
14986 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
14987 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
14988 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
14989 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Olivierce31e6e2014-09-05 18:49:10 +020014990 freely evolve depending on demands. You may find a description of all fields
14991 returned in src/dumpstats.c
14992
14993 The special id "all" dumps the states of all sessions, which must be avoided
14994 as much as possible as it is highly CPU intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014995
14996show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
14997 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
14998 possible to dump only selected items :
14999 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
15000 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
15001 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
15002 for example:
15003 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
15004 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
15005 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
15006
15007 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015008 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
15009 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015010 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
15011 Release_date: 2009/09/23
15012 Nbproc: 1
15013 Process_num: 1
15014 (...)
15015
15016 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
15017 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
15018 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
15019 (...)
15020 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
15021
15022 $
15023
15024 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
15025 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
15026 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
15027 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015028 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015029
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015030show table
15031 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
15032 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
15033 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
15034 entries currently in use.
15035
15036 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015037 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090015038 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
15039 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015040
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090015041show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015042 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
15043 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
15044 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090015045 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
15046
15047 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
15048 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
15049 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
15050 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
15051 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
15052
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015053 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
15054 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
15055 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
15056 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
15057 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
15058 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
15059
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090015060
15061 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090015062 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
15063 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090015064
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015065 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015066 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090015067 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015068 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
15069 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
15070 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15071 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015072
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015073 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090015074 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015075 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15076 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015077
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015078 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
15079 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090015080 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015081 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15082 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015083
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090015084 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
15085 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090015086 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090015087 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15088 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
15089
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015090 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
15091 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
15092 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
15093 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
15094 time goes, the average event rate drops.
15095
15096 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
15097 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
15098 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015099 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
15100 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015101 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
15102 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020015103
Nenad Merdanovicc6985f02015-05-09 08:46:02 +020015104show tls-keys
15105 Dump all loaded TLS ticket keys. The TLS ticket key reference ID and the
15106 file from which the keys have been loaded is shown. Both of those can be
15107 used to update the TLS keys using "set ssl tls-key".
15108
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020015109shutdown frontend <frontend>
15110 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
15111 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
15112 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
15113 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
15114 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
15115 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
15116 once it is terminated.
15117
15118 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
15119 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
15120
15121 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15122 level "admin".
15123
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020015124shutdown session <id>
15125 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
15126 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
15127 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
15128 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
15129 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
15130 flag in the logs.
15131
Cyril Bontée63a1eb2014-07-12 18:22:42 +020015132shutdown sessions server <backend>/<server>
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020015133 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
15134 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
15135 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
15136 'K' flag in the logs.
15137
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015138/*
15139 * Local variables:
15140 * fill-column: 79
15141 * End:
15142 */